Pilot's Guide
Pilot's Guide
Pilot's Guide
Pilot’s
Guide
© 2008-2016 Garmin Ltd. or its subsidiaries. All rights reserved.
Garmin International, Inc., 1200 East 151st Street, Olathe, KS 66062, U.S.A.
Tel: 913.397.8200 or 866.739.5687 Fax: 913.397.8282
Garmin AT, Inc., 2345 Turner Road SE, Salem, OR 97302, U.S.A. Tel: 503.581-8101 Fax 503.364.2138
Garmin (Europe) Ltd., Liberty House, Bulls Copse Road, Hounsdown Business Park, Southampton, SO40
9RB, U.K. Tel. +44 (0) 870 850 1243 Fax +44 (0) 238 052 4004
Garmin Corporation, No. 68, Jangshu 2nd Road, Xizhi Dist., New Taipei City 221, Taiwan (R.O.C.)
Tel: 886.02.2642.9199 Fax: 886.02.2642.9099
Garmin Singapore Pte., Ltd., 46 East Coast Road, #05-06 Eastgate, Singapore 428766
Tel: (65) 63480378 Fax: (65) 63480278
www.garmin.com
At Garmin, we value your opinion. For comments about this guide, please e-mail:
[email protected]
Except as expressly provided herein, no part of this manual may be reproduced, copied, transmitted,
disseminated, downloaded or stored in any storage medium, for any purpose without the express written
permission of Garmin. Garmin hereby grants permission to download a single copy of this manual and of
any revision to this manual onto a hard drive or other electronic storage medium to be viewed for personal
use, provided that such electronic or printed copy of this manual or revision must contain the complete text
of this copyright notice and provided further that any unauthorized commercial distribution of this manual
or any revision hereto is strictly prohibited.
Garmin®, FliteCharts®, and SafeTaxi® are registered trademarks of Garmin Ltd. or its subsidiaries. GDU™,
SVT™, G500, and G600 are trademarks of Garmin Ltd. or its subsidiaries. These trademarks may not be
used without the express permission of Garmin.
This part shall comply with Garmin Banned and Restricted Substances document, 001-00211-00.
Foreward
two years from the date of purchase for new Remote-Mount and Panel-Mount products; one year
from the date of purchase for new portable products and any purchased newly-overhauled products;
six months for newly-overhauled products exchanged through a Garmin Authorized Service Center;
and 90 days for factory repaired or newly-overhauled products exchanged at Garmin in lieu of repair.
System
Within the applicable period, Garmin will, at its sole option, repair or replace any components that
Sec 1
fail in normal use. Such repairs or replacement will be made at no charge to the customer for parts
or labor, provided that the customer shall be responsible for any transportation cost. This warranty
does not apply to: (i) cosmetic damage, such as scratches, nicks and dents; (ii) consumable parts,
Sec 2
such as batteries, unless product damage has occurred due to a defect in materials or workmanship;
PFD
(iii) damage caused by accident, abuse, misuse, water, flood, fire, or other acts of nature or external
causes; (iv) damage caused by service performed by anyone who is not an authorized service
provider of Garmin; or (v) damage to a product that has been modified or altered without the written
Sec 3
MFD
permission of Garmin. In addition, Garmin reserves the right to refuse warranty claims against
products or services that are obtained and/or used in contravention of the laws of any country.
THE WARRANTIES AND REMEDIES CONTAINED HEREIN ARE EXCLUSIVE AND IN LIEU OF ALL OTHER
Avoidance
Hazard
WARRANTIES, WHETHER EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STATUTORY, INCLUDING ANY LIABILITY ARISING
Sec 4
UNDER ANY WARRANTY OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE,
STATUTORY OR OTHERWISE. THIS WARRANTY GIVES YOU SPECIFIC LEGAL RIGHTS, WHICH MAY
VARY FROM STATE TO STATE.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
IN NO EVENT SHALL GARMIN BE LIABLE FOR ANY INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL
DAMAGES, WHETHER RESULTING FROM THE USE, MISUSE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PRODUCT OR
FROM DEFECTS IN THE PRODUCT. SOME STATES DO NOT ALLOW THE EXCLUSION OF INCIDENTAL OR
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, SO THE ABOVE LIMITATIONS MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Garmin retains the exclusive right to repair or replace (with a new or newly-overhauled replacement
product) the product or software or offer a full refund of the purchase price at its sole discretion.
SUCH REMEDY SHALL BE YOUR SOLE AND EXCLUSIVE REMEDY FOR ANY BREACH OF WARRANTY.
Symbols
Sec 7
Online Auction Purchases: Products purchased through online auctions are not eligible for
warranty coverage. Online auction confirmations are not accepted for warranty verification. To obtain
warranty service, an original or copy of the sales receipt from the original retailer is required. Garmin
will not replace missing components from any package purchased through an online auction.
Glossary
Sec 8
Distributor warranties are only valid in the area of intended distribution. Devices purchased in the
United States or Canada must be returned to the Garmin service center in the United Kingdom, the
United States, Canada, or Taiwan for service.
Index
To obtain warranty service, contact your local Garmin Authorized Service Center. For assistance in
locating a Service Center near you, visit the Garmin web site at http://www.garmin.com or contact
Garmin Customer Service at 866-739-5687.
WARNING: The displayed minimum safe altitudes (MSAs) are only advisory
in nature and should not be relied upon as the sole source of obstacle and
terrain avoidance information. Always refer to current aeronautical charts
for appropriate minimum clearance altitudes.
Sec 3
MFD
WARNING: The Garmin GDU 620 has a very high degree of functional
integrity. However, the pilot must recognize that providing monitoring and/
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
above Mean Sea Level and could vary significantly from the altitude
Sec 6
displayed by pressure altimeters, such as the output from the GDC 74A/74B
Air Data Computer, or other altimeters in aircraft. GPS altitude should never
be used for vertical navigation. Always use pressure altitude displayed by
Symbols
Sec 7
WARNING: Do not use basemap (land and water data) information for
primary navigation. Basemap data is intended only to supplement other
approved navigation data sources and should be considered as an aid to
enhance situational awareness.
Index
Foreward
maneuver the aircraft based only upon ATC guidance or positive visual
acquisition of conflicting traffic.
WARNING: Do not use data link weather information for maneuvering in,
System
Sec 1
near, or around areas of hazardous weather. Information contained within
data link weather products may not accurately depict current weather
conditions.
Sec 2
PFD
WARNING: Do not use the indicated data link weather product age to
determine the age of the weather information shown by the data link
weather product. Due to time delays inherent in gathering and processing
Sec 3
MFD
weather data for data link transmission, the weather information shown by
the data link weather product may be significantly older than the indicated
weather product age.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
WARNING: For safety reasons, GDU 620 operational procedures must be
learned on the ground.
Additional
Features
WARNING: To reduce the risk of unsafe operation, carefully review and
Sec 5
understand all aspects of the G500/G600 Pilot’s Guide. Thoroughly practice
basic operation prior to actual use. During flight operations, carefully
compare indications from the GDU 620 to all available navigation sources,
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
including the information from other NAVAIDs, visual sightings, charts, etc.
For safety purposes, always resolve any discrepancies before continuing
navigation.
Symbols
Sec 7
degrees per second in pitch or roll may invalidate AHRS attitude provided to the
GDU 620. Exceeding 435 KIAS may invalidate ADC information provided
to the GDU 620.
Appendix A
Index
of 70° South latitude. An area north of 65° North latitude and between
longitude 75° West and 120° West. An area north of 70° North latitude and
between longitude 70° West and 128° West. An area north of 70° North
latitude and between longitude 85° East and 114° East. An area south of
Sec 2
PFD
55° South latitude between longitude 120° East and 165° East.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreward
GPS system is subject to changes which could affect the accuracy and
performance of all GPS equipment. Portions of the Garmin GDU 620 utilize
GPS as a precision electronic NAVigation AID (NAVAID). Therefore, as with
all NAVAIDs, information presented by the GDU 620 can be misused or
System
Sec 1
misinterpreted and, therefore, become unsafe.
CAUTION: The Garmin GDU 620 does not contain any user-serviceable
parts. Repairs should only be made by an authorized Garmin service center.
Sec 2
PFD
Unauthorized repairs or modifications could void both the warranty and
the pilot’s authority to operate this device under FAA/FCC regulations.
CAUTION: The GDU 620 PFD and MFD displays use a lens coated with a
Sec 3
MFD
special anti-reflective coating that is very sensitive to skin oils, waxes, and
abrasive cleaners. CLEANERS CONTAINING AMMONIA WILL HARM THE
ANTI-REFLECTIVE COATING. It is very important to clean the lens using a
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
clean, lint-free cloth and an eyeglass lens cleaner that is specified as safe
for anti-reflective coatings.
Additional
CAUTION: FIS-B information is to be used for pilot planning
Features
Sec 5
decisions and pilot near-term decisions focused on avoiding areas
of inclement weather that are beyond visual range or where poor
visibility precludes visual acquisition of inclement weather. FIS-B
weather and NAS status information may be used as follows:
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
- To p r o m o t e p i l o t a w a r e n e s s o f o w n s h i p l o c a t i o n
w i t h r e s p e c t t o r e p o r t e d w e a t h e r, i n c l u d i n g h a z a r d o u s
meteorological conditions, NAS status indicators, and enhance
Symbols
NOTE: Do not rely solely upon data link services to provide Temporary Flight
Restriction (TFR) information. Always confirm TFR information through
Foreword
aircraft is on the ground. Moving the aircraft more than 100 feet away
from the source of the interference should alleviate the condition.
Sec 2
screen images of the GDU 620 bezel and displays, are subject to change
and may not reflect the most current GDU 620 system. Depictions of
equipment may differ slightly from the actual equipment.
Sec 3
MFD
NOTE: This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is
subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause
Avoidance
harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference
Hazard
Sec 4
NOTE: Terrain data is not displayed when the aircraft latitude is greater
Additional
Features
Record of Revisions
Foreward
Revision Date Description
J 11/2016 Update reflects software v7.12 upgrade.
H 03/2015 Update reflects software v7.10 upgrade.
System
Sec 1
G 02/2015 Update reflects software v7.00 upgrade.
F 10/2012 Update reflects software v6.11 upgrade.
E 08/2011 Update reflects software v6.00 uprade.
Sec 2
PFD
D 11/2010 Update reflects software v4.00 and v5.00 upgrades.
C 04/2009 Update reflects software v3.0 upgrade.
Sec 3
MFD
B 07/2008 Update includes various content edits.
A 06/2008 Product release.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Change Description
Foreword
2.5
Settings.”
2.9 Added “Radar Altimeter Configuration” section.
Additional
Features
3.1.5
Level.”
Added weather group and aviation group menu items and settings to
3.1.10
& Alerts
Foreward
5.5.3.8 Added “Field of View” section.
Updated screen image in figure 5-54, “Unusual Attitude
5.5.3.9 Display - Blue Band,” and figure 5-55, “Unusual Attitude
System
Sec 1
Display - Brown Band.”
Updated System LRUs screen image in figure 6-1, “System Status
6.1
Displays.”
Sec 2
PFD
7.1 Added VRP symbol to table 7-1, “Map Page Symbols.”
Added Designated Water Areas symbol to table 7-2, “SafeTaxi
7.2
Symbols.”
Sec 3
MFD
7.6 Updated ownship symbols in table 7-7, “Ownship Symbols.”
Added User Waypoint and Airspace Altitude Label symbols to
7.7
Avoidance
Hazard
table 7-8, “Miscellaneous Symbols.”
Sec 4
A.1.1 Added aviation database description.
A.1.2 Added aviation database to list of available databases.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
THAT RESULT FROM THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE SOFTWARE OR RELATED
PFD
AOPA FROM ANY CAUSES OF ACTION, CLAIMS OR LOSSES RELATED TO ANY ACTUAL OR
ALLEGED INACCURACIES IN THE INFORMATION. SOME JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW
THE LIMITATION OR EXCLUSION OF IMPLIED WARRANTIES OR LIABILITY FOR INCIDENTAL
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Contents
Foreward
1 System Overview..................................................................................1-1
1.1 System Description................................................................................. 1-1
System
1.1.1 Standard System Line Replaceable Units................................. 1-3
Sec 1
1.1.1.1 GDU 620............................................................................... 1-4
1.1.1.2 Air Data Computer................................................................. 1-5
1.1.1.3 Attitude Heading Reference System........................................ 1-5
Sec 2
PFD
1.1.1.4 GMU 44................................................................................. 1-9
1.1.1.5 GTP 59.................................................................................. 1-9
1.1.1.6 Garmin Navigator Interface..................................................... 1-9
Sec 3
MFD
1.1.2 Optional Line Replaceable Units........................................... 1-10
1.1.2.1 GDL 88................................................................................ 1-10
1.1.2.2 GTX 345.............................................................................. 1-10
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
1.1.2.3 Weather Radar..................................................................... 1-10
1.1.2.4 Stormscope.......................................................................... 1-10
1.1.2.5 GSR 56................................................................................ 1-11
Additional
Features
1.1.2.6 GDL 69/69A......................................................................... 1-11
Sec 5
1.1.2.7 GAD 43/43e......................................................................... 1-11
1.1.2.8 GTX 330/330D/335.............................................................. 1-12
1.2 System Power Up................................................................................. 1-13
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
1.3 International Geomagnetic Reference Field........................................... 1-15
1.4 System Operation................................................................................. 1-16
1.4.1 Pilot Controls....................................................................... 1-16
Symbols
Sec 7
Foreward
3.1.10.1 Map Feature Options............................................................ 3-10
3.1.10.2 Weather Feature Options (Optional)...................................... 3-17
3.1.10.3 Traffic Feature Options (Optional).......................................... 3-20
3.1.10.4 Aviation Feature Options...................................................... 3-21
System
Sec 1
3.1.11 Split Screen (Optional).......................................................... 3-26
3.2 Aux Mode Pages.................................................................................. 3-27
3.2.1 System Settings.................................................................... 3-27
Sec 2
PFD
3.2.1.1 Display Brightness................................................................ 3-28
3.2.1.2 Airspeed Reference Marks.................................................... 3-29
3.2.1.3 PFD Options - Wind Vector.................................................... 3-30
Sec 3
MFD
3.2.1.4 PFD Options - Nav Status..................................................... 3-30
3.2.1.5 Temperature Reference......................................................... 3-31
3.2.1.6 Synchronization.................................................................... 3-32
Avoidance
Hazard
3.2.1.7 Date and Time...................................................................... 3-34
Sec 4
3.2.1.8 MFD Display Units................................................................ 3-35
3.2.1.9 System Display Units............................................................ 3-36
Additional
3.2.1.10 Data Link............................................................................. 3-37
Features
Sec 5
3.2.2 Sirius XM Information (Optional)........................................... 3-38
3.2.3 Sirius XM Entertainment Radio (Optional)............................. 3-39
3.2.4 System Status....................................................................... 3-40
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
3.2.4.1 Database Sync Operation...................................................... 3-41
3.2.4.2 Resolving Database Conflicts................................................ 3-45
3.2.4.3 Chart Streaming................................................................... 3-46
Symbols
Sec 7
4 Hazard Avoidance.................................................................................4-1
4.1 Terrain Configurations............................................................................ 4-2
4.1.1 Terrain System Self-Test.......................................................... 4-3
Additional
Features
Foreward
4.3.5.7 Negative Climb Rate After Take-Off Alert............................... 4-23
4.3.5.8 TAWS Not Available Alert...................................................... 4-24
4.3.5.9 TAWS Failure Alert................................................................ 4-24
4.3.6 TAWS System Status............................................................. 4-24
System
Sec 1
4.4 External TAWS..................................................................................... 4-25
4.5 Terrain-SVT.......................................................................................... 4-26
4.5.1 Terrain-SVT Page 120° Arc or 360° Rings.............................. 4-27
Sec 2
PFD
4.5.2 Terrain-SVT Page Aviation Data............................................. 4-28
4.5.3 Inhibiting/Enabling Terrain-SVT Alerting................................. 4-28
4.5.4 Synthetic Vision Alerts and Annunciations.............................. 4-29
Sec 3
MFD
4.6 Traffic Systems..................................................................................... 4-31
4.6.1 TAS/TCAS 1 Traffic (Optional)................................................ 4-31
4.6.1.1 Displaying and Operating Traffic (TAS/TCAS Systems)............. 4-32
Avoidance
Hazard
4.6.1.2 Switching from Standby Mode to Operating Modes............... 4-32
Sec 4
4.6.1.3 Range Ring.......................................................................... 4-33
4.6.1.4 Altitude Display.................................................................... 4-33
Additional
4.6.1.5 TAS/TCAS Symbology........................................................... 4-34
Features
Sec 5
4.6.1.6 Traffic System Status............................................................. 4-35
4.6.1.7 Traffic Pop-Up...................................................................... 4-37
4.6.2 TIS Traffic (Optional)............................................................. 4-38
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
4.6.2.1 Traffic Map Page.................................................................. 4-38
4.6.2.2 TIS Symbology...................................................................... 4-40
4.6.2.3 TIS Limitations...................................................................... 4-41
Symbols
Sec 7
Foreward
4.8.6.1 Displaying Weather on the Weather Radar Page.................. 4-104
4.8.6.2 Vertically Scanning a Storm Cell ......................................... 4-105
4.8.6.3 Adjusting the Antenna Tilt Angle......................................... 4-106
4.8.6.4 Adjusting Gain................................................................... 4-107
System
Sec 1
4.8.6.5 Sector Scan - GWX Radars Only.......................................... 4-109
4.8.6.6 Antenna Stabilization......................................................... 4-110
4.8.6.7 Weather Attenuated Color Highlight - GWX Radars Only..... 4-110
Sec 2
PFD
4.8.6.8 Weather Alert - GWX Radars Only....................................... 4-111
4.8.6.9 Altitude Compensated Tilt - GWX 70 Only........................... 4-112
4.8.6.10 Turbulence Detection - GWX 70 Only (Optional).................. 4-112
Sec 3
MFD
4.8.6.11 Ground Clutter Suppression - GWX 70 Only (Optional)........ 4-112
4.8.7 Ground Mapping and Interpretation................................... 4-113
4.9 GFDS Weather (Optional)................................................................... 4-114
Avoidance
Hazard
4.9.1 GFDS Registration.............................................................. 4-115
Sec 4
4.9.1.1 Registering with GFDS........................................................ 4-115
4.9.1.2 Deactivating Unit Registration With GFDS........................... 4-116
Additional
4.9.2 Using GFDS Satellite Weather Products............................... 4-116
Features
Sec 5
4.9.3 Customizing the GFDS Weather Map.................................. 4-116
4.9.4 GFDS Data Request............................................................ 4-118
4.9.4.1 GFDS Data Request Coverage............................................. 4-119
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
4.9.4.2 GFDS Data Request Auto Request....................................... 4-122
4.9.4.3 GFDS Data Request Manual Request.................................. 4-123
4.9.4.4 GFDS Data Request Status Window.................................... 4-123
Symbols
Sec 7
Foreward
5.3.3 Sirius XM Satellite Radio Entertainment................................ 5-25
5.3.3.1 Channel Categories.............................................................. 5-26
5.3.3.2 Selecting a Sirius XM Satellite Radio Channel........................ 5-27
5.3.3.3 Sirius XM Satellite Radio Volume........................................... 5-28
System
Sec 1
5.3.3.4 Sirius XM Satellite Radio Channel Presets............................. 5-29
5.3.4 GDL 69/69A Data Link Receiver Troubleshooting................... 5-30
5.4 Autopilot Operation............................................................................. 5-31
Sec 2
PFD
5.4.1 GAD 43 Attitude.................................................................. 5-31
5.4.2 Heading............................................................................... 5-32
5.4.3 Altitude Capture (Optional Upgrade)..................................... 5-32
Sec 3
MFD
5.4.4 Autopilot Navigation............................................................ 5-33
5.4.4.1 Autopilot Operation with GPSS Enabled Autopilots................ 5-33
5.4.4.2 Autopilot Operation with the GDU 620 Emulating GPSS........ 5-34
Avoidance
Hazard
5.4.5 Flight Director Display........................................................... 5-34
Sec 4
5.4.6 Vertical Speed Control.......................................................... 5-35
5.4.7 Autopilot Mode Annunciations............................................. 5-36
Additional
5.5 Synthetic Vision Technology (Optional).................................................. 5-37
Features
Sec 5
5.5.1 SVT Operation...................................................................... 5-38
5.5.2 Activating and Deactivating SVT........................................... 5-39
5.5.3 SVT Features........................................................................ 5-40
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
5.5.3.1 Flight Path Marker................................................................ 5-40
5.5.3.2 Zero-Pitch Line..................................................................... 5-40
5.5.3.3 Horizon Heading.................................................................. 5-41
Symbols
Sec 7
8 Glossary................................................................................................8-1
Sec 1
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
1 SYSTEM OVERVIEW
Foreword
1.1 System Description
This section provides an overview of the G500/G600 Avionics Display System.
The G500/G600 system is an integrated display system that presents primary
System
Sec 1
flight instrumentation, navigation, and a moving map to the pilot through large-
format displays.
In normal operating mode, the Primary Flight Display (PFD) presents
Sec 2
PFD
graphical flight instrumentation (attitude, heading, airspeed, altitude, vertical
speed), replacing the traditional flight instrument cluster. The Multi-Function
Display (MFD) normally displays a full-color moving map with navigation
Sec 3
MFD
information, as well as supplemental data.
GMU 44 Magnetometer Garmin Navigator(s) GTP 59 Temperature Probe
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
GDU 620
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
AHRS
Optional Interfaces
Autopilot Weather Radar GAD 43/43e
Audio Panel Traffic
Flight Director Datalink Altimeter
Glossary
ADF DME
Radio Radar Video
GNS 500W series, GTN 600 series, GTN 700 series, or a compatible
GPS Navigator
Interfaces to various other aircraft systems and equipment are supported,
Sec 3
MFD
including:
• GAD 43/43e Adapter
Avoidance
Hazard
• Autopilot/Flight Director
Annun.
Sec 6
• ADF
• Garmin GTS or GTX traffic awareness systems, or selected third-party
Symbols
Sec 7
devices
• Audio Panel
• Garmin GWX radar systems or selected third-party radars
Glossary
Sec 8
• Radar Altimeter
• Video Sources
Appendix A
• Stormscope
Index
Foreword
under 6,000 lbs.)
Approved for Class 2 Aircraft (typically piston twins Yes Yes/No
and turbine aircraft under 6,000 lbs.)
System
Sec 1
Approved for Class 3 Aircraft (typically piston or No Yes
turbine aircraft between 6,000 lbs. and 12,500 lbs.)
Software design assurance level Level C Level B
Sec 2
PFD
Garmin SVT Synthetic Vision Technology Optional Standard
GAD 43/43e replaces old A/P gyro attitude with Optional Standard
AHRS references; GAD 43e adds additional
Sec 3
MFD
interfaces with other avionics
GWX 68/70 Radar interface (radar LRU sold Optional Standard
separately)
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Interface support for other ARINC 708 radars Optional Optional
RVSM capable on select aircraft No Optional
Additional
Internal TAWS-B terrain alerting No Optional
Features
Sec 5
Table 1-1 G500/G600 System Comparison
map all displayed on dual color screens. The G500/G600 system is composed
of sub-units or Line Replaceable Units (LRUs). LRUs have a modular design and
Glossary
bay if desired. This design greatly eases troubleshooting and maintenance of the
G500/G600 system. A failure or problem can be isolated to a particular LRU,
Appendix A
which can be replaced quickly and easily. Each LRU has a particular function, or
set of functions, that contributes to the system’s operation.
Index
left side of the GDU is a PFD and the right side is the MFD. In some models or
installations, the PFD and MFD and their controls are switched to the other side.
The MFD shows a moving map, flight plan, weather, and other supplemental
System
Sec 1
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Figure 1-3 GDU 620 PFD and MFD with PFD on Right
Index
Foreword
system and an Outside Air Temperature (OAT) sensor. The ADC provides
pressure altitude, airspeed, vertical speed, and OAT information to the
G500/G600 system. The ADC communicates with the GDU 620 and AHRS
System
Sec 1
using an ARINC 429 digital interface.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Figure 1-4 Air Data Computer
1.1.1.3 Attitude Heading Reference System
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
NOTE: Aggressive maneuvering while the AHRS is not operating in normal
mode may degrade AHRS accuracy.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
The Attitude and Heading Reference System (AHRS) unit provides aircraft
attitude information to the G500/G600 display. The unit contains advanced
accelerometers and rate sensors and interfaces with both the ADC and the
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
GMU 44 magnetometer. The AHRS utilizes GPS data forwarded from the
GDU 620. Attitude and heading information is sent to the GDU 620 using an
ARINC 429 digital interface.
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
out of date, the user is prompted to update. The prompt will appear after the
G500/G600 splash screen is acknowledged on the MFD.
190-00601-02 Rev. J Garmin G500/G600 Pilot’s Guide 1-5
Cover TOC
Attitude and heading information is displayed on the PFD when the AHRS
receives appropriate combinations of information from the external sensor
Foreword
inputs.
AHRS Inputs AHRS AHRS Outputs
GPS Magnetometer Air Data Mode Attitude Heading
System
Sec 1
Symbols
Sec 7
heading information. This is indicated by red “X” flags over the corresponding
flight instruments.
Index
A maximum of two GPS inputs are provided to the AHRS. If GPS information
from one of the inputs fails, the AHRS uses the remaining GPS input and an
Foreword
alert message is issued to inform the pilot. If both GPS inputs fail, the AHRS
will continue to provide attitude and heading information to the PFD as long as
magnetometer and airspeed data are available and valid.
System
Sec 1
If the magnetometer input fails, the AHRS continues to output valid attitude
information and GPS Track information is used. However, the PFD heading
display is flagged as invalid with a red “X” and “TRK” is annunciated to the
Sec 2
right of the Track value in magenta. The Track value color changes from white
PFD
to magenta.
NOTE: In this case the magnetic standby compass and GPS ground track
Sec 3
MFD
can be used to keep the aircraft on the desired heading.
Avoidance
will change back to HDG up when heading is restored.
Hazard
Sec 4
When heading fails, the heading bug is not removed and the GDU continues
driving the autopilot heading error output using track in place of heading.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Heading Failed Track Mode Active Symbols
Sec 7
Figure 1-7 Track Mode shown as Active when Heading Info has failed
Sec 8
Failure of the air data input has no effect on the AHRS output while AHRS is
receiving valid GPS information. Invalid or unavailable airspeed data, in addition
Appendix A
to complete GPS failure, results in loss of all attitude and heading information.
Index
NOTE: Fastest AHRS alignment is achieved with the aircraft stationary and
with all AHRS inputs valid (3-D GPS position, magnetometer, and air data).
Foreword
NOTE: Depending on the AHRS type and the magnitude of the heading error,
the displayed indication may change directly from unreliable to reliable.
Additional
Features
Align Heading
Align Heading
Index
1.1.1.4 GMU 44
The GMU 44 magnetometer senses the earth’s magnetic field. Data is sent
Foreword
to the AHRS for processing to determine aircraft magnetic heading. This unit
receives power directly from the AHRS and communicates with the AHRS using
a RS-485 digital interface.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Figure 1-10 GMU 44 Magnetometer
1.1.1.5 GTP 59
Sec 3
MFD
The GTP 59 temperature probe provides Outside Air Temperature (OAT)
data to the ADC.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 1-11 GTP 59 Temperature Probe
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
1.1.1.6 Garmin Navigator Interface
The G500/G600 system requires connection to at least one external Garmin
Symbols
WAAS GPS navigator, such as the 400W/500W series, GTN 600/700 series, or
Sec 7
GNS 480.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
system.
1.1.2.1 GDL 88
System
models of the GDL 88. Models with a single bottom mounted UAT antenna
meet TSO C154c Class A1S and are available with or without an internal
GPS/SBAS receiver. Models with one top mounted and one bottom mounted antenna
Sec 2
PFD
meet TSO C154c Class A1H and are also available with or without an internal
GPS/SBAS receiver.
1.1.2.2 GTX 345
Sec 3
MFD
The GTX 345 is a combined mode S/ES transponder and ADS-B transceiver.
Mode S/ES models have an optional internal GPS/SBAS receiver.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
The GDU only displays ADS-B information, it does not control the GTX.
1.1.2.3 Weather Radar
Additional
The Garmin GWX system, or selected 3rd party radar, provides airborne
Features
Sec 5
Symbols
Sec 7
NOTE: Refer to the WX-500 Pilot’s Guide for a detailed description of the
WX-500 StormScope.
Appendix A
the information to the display. Interfaces are currently only available for the
WX-500 StormScope System.
1.1.2.5 GSR 56
The GSR 56 is an Iridium satellite transceiver that supports voice telephone
Foreword
calls, aircraft position reporting, and world wide weather products.
1.1.2.6 GDL 69/69A
The GDL 69/69A is a Sirius XM Satellite Radio Data Link Receiver that
System
Sec 1
receives broadcast weather data. The GDL 69A is the same as the GDL 69
with the addition of an Sirius XM Satellite Radio audio entertainment receiver.
Weather data and control of audio channel and volume is displayed on the MFD,
Sec 2
PFD
via a High-Speed Data Bus (HSDB) Ethernet connection. The GDL 69A is also
interfaced to an audio panel for distribution of the audio signal. A subscription
to the Sirius XM Satellite Radio service is required to enable the GDL 69/69A
Sec 3
MFD
capability. Subscription information is available at: http://www.garmin.com/xm/.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 1-13 GDL 69/69A XM Satellite Radio Data Link Receiver
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
1.1.2.7 GAD 43/43e
The GAD 43 is an adapter that converts AHRS digital pitch, roll, heading
Symbols
and yaw rate data into analog signals used by autopilot systems. The GAD 43
Sec 7
is installed remotely between the AHRS and an existing autopilot. The analog
signals from the GAD 43 mimic those of spinning-mass gyros that provide data
Glossary
to the autopilot and allow the gyro to be replaced by the AHRS and GAD 43
Sec 8
combination.
The GAD 43e performs the same functions as the GAD 43, but adds support
Appendix A
for additional interfaces to various aircraft systems. The GAD 43e supports
interfaces to various autopilots (for altitude preselect and vertical speed control),
analog NAV radios, DME, analog radar altimeters, marker beacons, and ADF
receivers.
Index
display through an ARINC 429 digital interface. In the following figure, the
Features
Sec 5
Foreword
NOTE: See the Aircraft Flight Manual (AFM) for specific procedures
concerning avionics power application and emergency power supply
operation.
System
Sec 1
NOTE: Refer to section 6 for system-specific annunciations and alerts.
The G500/G600 System is integrated with the aircraft electrical system and
receives power directly from electrical busses. The GDU 620 and supporting
Sec 2
PFD
sub-systems include both power-on and continuous built-in test features that
exercise the processor, memory, external inputs, and outputs to ensure safe
operation.
Sec 3
MFD
During system initialization, test annunciations are displayed. All system
annunciations should disappear typically within the first 30 seconds after power-
up. Upon power-up, bezel key backlights also become momentarily illuminated
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
on the GDU 620 display bezel.
On the PFD, the AHRS begins to initialize and “AHRS ALIGN: Keep Wings
Level” is displayed. The AHRS should display valid attitude and heading fields
Additional
Features
Sec 5
typically within the first minute after power-up. The AHRS can align itself both
while taxiing and during level flight.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
NOTE: Fastest AHRS alignment is achieved with the aircraft stationary and
with all AHRS inputs valid (3-D GPS position, magnetometer, and air data).
During initial power up on the ground, no GPS position and/or magnetic
anomalies are common. If the aircraft is taxied prior to AHRS alignment,
Symbols
Sec 7
alignment may be delayed until after a valid 3-D GPS position is available.
maneuvering. The AHRS will align with shallow banking and pitch angles
(less than 20 degrees of roll or 5 degrees of pitch). AHRS alignment may
not be possible during more aggressive maneuvers.
Appendix A
Index
When the MFD powers up, the splash screen displays the following
information:
Foreword
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Foreword
The IGRF (International Geomagnetic Reference Field) model is contained
in the AHRS and is only updated once every five years. The IGRF model is
part of the Navigation Database. At system power-up, the IGRF models in the
AHRS and in the Navigation Database are compared, and if the IGRF model
System
Sec 1
in the AHRS is out of date, the user is prompted to update the IGRF model in
the AHRS. After the G500H splash screen is acknowledged on the MFD, the
following update message appears.
Sec 2
PFD
For GRS 77/79: For GSU 75:
GRS MV DB UPDATE AVAILABLE: GSU AHRS MV DB UPDATE AVAILABLE:
UPDATE AS FOLLOWS? UPDATE AS FOLLOWS?
yyyy to yyyy yyyy to yyyy
Sec 3
MFD
###-#####-## to ###-#####-## ###-#####-## to ###-#####-##
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
1. When the Update message appears, press the ENT key with “OK” highlighted.
To update at another time, turn the Large knob to highlight “Cancel” and then
Additional
press ENT.
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
2. After the update is complete, press the ENT key to continue normal operation.
The GDU 620 controls have been designed to simplify operation of the system
and minimize workload and the time required to access functionality. Controls
are located on the PFD and MFD bezels and are comprised of a PFD knob, MFD
Sec 2
PFD
1. Press the desired PFD mode selection key (HDG, CRS, ALT, V/S, or BARO).
A window will be displayed near the upper left corner of the HSI showing the
current value for that mode.
Glossary
Sec 8
Foreword
NOTE: See section 5.4 for autopilot functions using the PFD Bezel Keys.
Heading (HDG)
Selects Heading Select mode. This is the default mode for the PFD knob.
System
Sec 1
Pressing the PFD knob in Heading mode will center the Heading Bug on the
current Heading. Set the heading bug on the HSI by turning the PFD knob after
pressing the HDG key.
Sec 2
PFD
Course (CRS)
Selects Course Select mode. Pressing the PFD knob in Course mode will
center the CDI for a VOR or GPS OBS course.
Sec 3
MFD
Altimeter (ALT)
Selects Altitude Select mode. Pressing the PFD knob in Altitude Select mode
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
will enter the current altitude in the Altitude Select window. Set the Altitude Bug
by turning the PFD knob after pressing the ALT key.
Altitude Select Window
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Altitude Bug
Annun.
Current Altitude Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Barometric Setting
Appendix A
Figure 1-19 Pressing PFD Knob Sets Altitude Select to Current Altitude
Index
Figure 1-20 Pressing V/S Knob Sets Vertical Speed Bug to Current Vertical Speed
For aircraft with vertical speed operating limitations, red bands showing
Additional
Features
Vertical Speed Maximum and Minimum ranges will be shown on the left side of
Sec 5
the Vertical Speed tape. When the Vertical Speed Indicator is in one of the red
ranges, the background color of the Vertical Speed Indicator will turn red.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Barometer (BARO)
Selects Barometric Setting Select mode. Pressing the PFD knob in Baro mode
Foreword
toggles between standard pressure (29.92 in/1013 mb) and the previously
selected value.
1.4.1.3 MFD Knobs
System
Sec 1
The MFD knobs are for navigating and selecting information on the MFD
pages. More details are provided in the MFD section.
Small (Inner) MFD Knob
Sec 2
PFD
Selects a specific page within a page group. Pressing the small MFD knob
turns the selection cursor ON and OFF. When the cursor is ON, data may be
Sec 3
entered in the applicable window by turning the small and large MFD knobs. In
MFD
this case, the large MFD knob moves the cursor on the page and the small MFD
knob selects individual characters or values for the highlighted cursor location.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Large (Outer) MFD Knob
Selects the MFD page group. When the cursor is ON, the large MFD knob
moves the cursor to highlight available fields.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
1.4.1.4 MFD Bezel Keys
Range (RNG)
& Alerts
Annun.
Pressing the Range arrow keys changes the range on the Map pages. The Up
Sec 6
arrow zooms out. The Down arrow zooms in. The keys also aid in scrolling up
and down text pages.
Symbols
Menu
Sec 7
Displays a context-sensitive list of options. This list allows the user to access
additional features or make setting changes that relate to particular pages.
Glossary
Sec 8
Enter (ENT)
Validates or confirms a menu selection or data entry.
Appendix A
Clear (CLR)
Erases information, cancels entries, or removes page menus. Pressing and
holding the CLR key displays the Navigation Map 1 page.
Index
labels shown depend on the soft key level or page being displayed. The bezel
keys below the soft keys can be used to select the appropriate soft key.
MFD functions indicated by the soft key labels vary depending on the page
System
Sec 1
selected and are located at the bottom of the MFD display. Press the soft key
located directly below the soft key label. To select the function indicated on the
soft key label, press the soft key directly below the label.
Sec 2
PFD
The GDU 620 has a dedicated MENU key that when pressed displays a
context-sensitive list of options for functions in the MFD. This options list allows
the user to access additional features or make settings changes which specifically
& Alerts
Annun.
menu. Some menus provide access to additional submenus that are used to view,
edit, select, and review options. Menus display “No Options” when there are no
Symbols
options for the window/page selected. Soft key presses do not display menus or
Sec 7
submenus.
Navigating within a Menu
Glossary
Sec 8
scroll bar always appears to the right of the window/box when the option list
is longer than the window/box).
3. Press the ENT key to select the desired option.
Index
4. Press the CLR key or MFD knob to remove the menu and cancel the operation.
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Figure 1-23 Page Menu Examples
Sec 2
PFD
Setup Page. For details on changing settings, refer to section 3, “Aux Mode
Pages.”
1. From the first AUX page, press the small MFD knob and turn the large MFD
Sec 3
MFD
knob to highlight the desired value.
2. Turn the small MFD knob to select “ON” or “OFF.”
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
3. Press ENTER to save the setting.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
VX (or V1)
VY (or V2)
Synchronization CDI - On/Off Crossfill Nav
Sec 2
PFD
On/Off
PFD Options Off, Style 1 - Style 4 PFD wind vector display Nav Status
(Wind Vector) format. option not
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Data/Time Date
Time
Time Format
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Time Offset
Temperature SAT, TAT, ISA
Reference
Symbols
Sec 7
Foreword
Vertical Speed Meters Vertical
Speed
Indicator
System
Sec 1
Navigation Angle Magnetic (North) Heading
True (North) Course
Bearing
Track
Sec 2
PFD
Desired Track
Barometric Setting Inches (in) Barometric pressure on
Hectopascals (hpa) PFD
Temperature Celsius All temperatures on PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Fahrenheit
Data Link (WX/TFR XM Select weather source.
Source) FIS
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
GFDS
Table 1-4 Display Units Settings (System Setup Page)
Additional
Features
Sec 5
The backlighting of the PFD and MFD displays and bezel keys can be
adjusted automatically or manually. The default setting (automatic backlighting
adjustment) uses the photocell located at the top right corner of the bezel to
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
automatically adjust for ambient lighting conditions. Photocell calibration
curves are configured by the installer to optimize display appearance through a
broad range of cockpit lighting conditions. Display backlighting adjustment can
Symbols
Sec 7
Backlighting Adjustment
1. From the first AUX page, press the small MFD knob to highlight the “DISPLAY
Foreword
Auto or Manual
3. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight the MODE field. Turn the small MFD
knob to select “AUTO” or “MANUAL” and then press ENT.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
bezel keys on the side of the PFD and the soft keys below the PFD.
Horizon Slip/Skid Roll Scale Roll
Line Indicator Zero Pointer
System
Sec 1
Nav Status Bar
Altitude Tape
Air Speed Tape
Sec 2
PFD
PFD Knob Mode Indicator
Current
Wind Vectors Barometric
Sec 3
MFD
Pressure Setting
Heading Bug Select
Vertical
Course Select Speed Tape
Avoidance
Altitude Bug Select
Hazard
Sec 4
Vertical Speed Bug Select Horizontal
Situation
Barometric Setting Select Indicator
Air Temperature
Additional
Features
SD Card Slots
Sec 5
PFD Knob
NOTE: When navigating to a waypoint very far away, the DTK, CRS, and
TRK values displayed on the GDU 620 may differ from those displayed
on the navigator, however the CDI is correct and is the primary means
of navigation. This is because the GDU 620 applies magnetic variation
Index
corrections for the current aircraft location, but some navigators apply
magnetic variation correction for the waypoint location.
DME NAV 1
DME NAV 2
DME HOLD
Sec 3
MFD
BRG
BRG 1
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
NAV 1
GPS 1
ADF
Additional
Features
BRG 2
Sec 5
NAV 2
GPS 2
& Alerts
Annun.
ADF
Sec 6
CLK/TMR
HIDE
Symbols
Sec 7
CLOCK/TIMER
START/STOP
RESET
Glossary
BACK
Sec 8
labels. The soft key labels shown depend on the soft key level or page being
displayed. The soft keys can be used to select the appropriate soft key function.
Index
Foreword
Soft Key Labels
Soft Keys
System
Sec 1
Soft Key Not Available
Unselected Soft Key For Selection
Sec 2
PFD
Figure 2-4 PFD Soft Key Layout
When a soft key is selected, its color changes to black text on gray background
and remains this way until it is turned off, at which time it reverts to white text
Sec 3
MFD
on black background. When a soft key function is disabled, the soft key label is
subdued (dimmed).
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
NOTE: If a soft key is pressed and held for longer than 1 second, it is
ignored.
AP Test
Additional
Features
Sec 5
The AP TEST soft key is available if the GAD 43 is used to provide attitude
information to an autopilot. The AP TEST soft key disengages the autopilot as
part of the GAD 43 test.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
CDI
The CDI soft key toggles between the selection of GPS or VOR/LOC as the
Symbols
active navigation source. In a single GDU 620 system, the GDU CDI soft key will
Sec 7
change the source in the connected navigator and making a source change in the
navigator will be reflected in the GDU 620. In a dual GDU 620 system, the CDI
keys in the navigator will be disabled.
Glossary
Sec 8
1-2
The 1-2 soft key toggles between the available receivers for selected
Appendix A
navigation source (i.e. GPS1 and GPS2 or VOR/LOC1 and VOR/LOC2). This
soft key will only be present if the system is configured for a second GPS or
VOR/LOC.
Index
PFD
Pressing the PFD soft key displays the SYN VIS, DME, BRG, and BACK
Foreword
soft keys. The DME and SYN VIS soft keys will only be present if the system is
configured for these features.
BRG1
System
Sec 1
The BRG1 soft key cycles through the available bearing 1 indicator modes
(NAV1, GPS1, ADF, or None).
BRG2
Sec 2
PFD
The BRG2 soft key cycles through the available bearing 2 indicator modes
(NAV2, GPS2, ADF, or None). This soft key will only be present if the system is
configured for a second GPS or VOR/LOC.
Sec 3
MFD
DME
The DME NAV soft keys select the DME submenu. For some installations,
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
the DME NAV soft keys simply toggle the DME display on/off as the submenu
options will not exist. The availability of the DME controls vary based on the
installation.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
The DME NAV soft keys select NAV 1 or 2 as the DME tuning source. If this
soft key is pressed again when already selected, the DME display is removed
from the PFD. Not all installations will have both NAV1 and NAV2 soft keys.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
DME HOLD
DME HOLD activates/deactivates the DME tuning hold function. DME HOLD
may be selected for either DME NAV 1 or DME NAV 2. The Hold function
Appendix A
The SYN VIS soft key is available if Synthetic Vision Technology is installed.
It enables Synthetic Vision and displays the associated soft keys.
SYN TERR
The SYN TERR soft key is available if Synthetic Vision Technology is installed
Foreword
and enables synthetic terrain depiction.
HRZN HDG
The HRZN HDG soft key is available if Synthetic Vision Technology is
System
Sec 1
installed. Pressing this key enables horizon heading marks and digits.
APTSIGNS
Sec 2
PFD
The APTSIGNS soft key is available if Synthetic Vision Technology is
installed and enables airport sign posts.
CLK/TMR
Sec 3
MFD
The Clock/Timer function displays a clock or timer window in the lower left
corner of the PFD.
Select
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Hide Clock Timer
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Hide Timer Select Start Reset
Clock Timer Timer
Figure 2-6 Clock and Timer Functions
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
BACK
The BACK soft key returns to the previous soft key menu.
Symbols
marked at intervals of 10 units, while minor tick marks on the moving tape are
Sec 8
NOTE: Airspeed units (KTS, MPH, KPH) are configured to match the approved
units for the installation.
The Airspeed Indicator provides Indicated Airspeed, True Airspeed, and
Index
Ground Speed. The Airspeed Trend Indicator shows what the airspeed will be
in six seconds, if the current acceleration is maintained. The actual airspeed is
displayed inside the black pointer.
190-00601-02 Rev. J Garmin G500/G600 Pilot’s Guide 2-5
Cover TOC
strip. The end of the trend vector corresponds to the predicted airspeed in six
seconds if the current acceleration is maintained. If the trend vector crosses into
the overspeed range, the text of the digital airspeed readout changes to yellow.
System
The trend vector is absent if the speed remains constant or if any data needed to
Sec 1
Vr Reference Marker
Sec 3
MFD
Vx Reference Marker
Vy Reference Marker
Hazard
Sec 4
True Airspeed
Sec 5
Airspeed Units
Figure 2-7 Airspeed Tape
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Current Airspeed
Glossary
2.2.1 Markings
A color-coded (white, green, yellow, and red/white “barber pole”) speed
Foreword
range strip is located on the moving tape. The colors are configured to match
the approved markings for the installation. Refer to the AFM/POH.
System
Sec 1
NOTE: The actual colors and patterns of the airspeed tape may vary by
installation. See your AFM/POH for more details.
Sec 2
PFD
Mmo / Vmo / VNE
Sec 3
MFD
VNO
VFE
VS1
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
VSO
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 2-9 Typical Airspeed Tape Markings
& Alerts
Annun.
White Triangle Sec 6
VYSE
Symbols
Sec 7
VLE
Glossary
VMCA
Sec 8
process, but can be changed and turned on/off from the System Setup page
on the first page of the Aux page group. When active (on), the V-speeds are
displayed at their respective locations to the right of the airspeed scale.
System
Sec 1
Vr Reference Marker
Sec 2
PFD
Vx Reference Marker
Vy Reference Marker
Sec 3
MFD
V1 Reference Marker
Vr Reference Marker
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Foreword
Attitude information is displayed over a virtual blue sky and brown ground
with a white horizon line. The Attitude Indicator displays pitch, roll, and
slip/skid information.
System
Sec 1
9 1 Roll Pointer
2 Roll Scale
1 3 Aircraft Symbol
7
Sec 2
PFD
4 Horizon Line
2
8 5 Land Representation
6 Pitch Scale
Sec 3
MFD
3 6
7 Slip/Skid Indicator
8 Sky Representation
Avoidance
Hazard
4
Sec 4
5 9 Roll Scale Zero
Additional
Features
Sec 5
The horizon line is part of the pitch scale. Above and below the horizon line,
major pitch marks and numeric labels are shown for every 10º, up to 80º. Minor
pitch marks are shown for intervening 5º increments, up to 25º below and 45º
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
above the horizon line. Between 20º below to 20º above the horizon line, minor
pitch marks occur every 2.5º.
Angle of bank is indicated by the position of the pointer on the roll scale.
Symbols
Sec 7
Major tick marks are 30º and 60º and minor tick marks are 10º, 20º, and 45º
are shown to the left and right of the zero.
The Slip/Skid Indicator is the bar beneath the roll pointer. The indicator
Glossary
Sec 8
moves with the roll pointer and moves laterally away from the pointer to
indicate lateral acceleration. Slip/skid is indicated by the location of the bar
Appendix A
relative to the pointer. One bar displacement (as shown below) is equal to one
ball displacement on a traditional Slip/Skid Indicator.
Index
Roll Pointer
Slip/Skid Indicator
System
Sec 1
Pointer or a Roll Pointer configuration. The GDU 620 Attitude Indicator has
been configured in either a Ground Pointer or a Roll Pointer configuration to
match the configuration of your aircraft’s standby Attitude Indicator. Ground/
Sec 3
MFD
Sky Pointer mode is configured during installation and can not be changed by
the pilot.
Avoidance
In an aircraft with an Attitude Indicator that has a Ground Pointer, the pointer
Hazard
Sec 4
above the Roll Scale shifts with the roll or bank angle of the aircraft to keep the
Roll Scale Zero Pointer pointing towards the ground.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Roll Scale
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Figure 2-15 Attitude Indicator with Ground Pointer Configuration in a Left Turn
In an aircraft with an Attitude Indicator that has a Sky Pointer, the pointer
below the roll scale shifts with the roll or bank angle of the aircraft to keep the
Glossary
Sec 8
Roll Pointer
Roll Scale
Index
Figure 2-16 Attitude Indicator with Sky Pointer Configuration in Left Turn
Foreword
or 20º pitch down. Red chevrons are displayed at greater than 50º pitch up and
30º pitch down. The PFD will “declutter” when the aircraft enters an extreme
attitude. Only the primary functions will be displayed in these situations.
System
The following information is removed from the PFD (and corresponding soft
Sec 1
keys are disabled) when the aircraft is in an unusual attitude:
• BARO and Radar Altimeter • Outside Air Temperature
Minimums
Sec 2
• Radar Altimeter Digital Readout
PFD
• Clock/Timer Field •
Selected Altitude, Barometer
• DME Field Setting, and Selected Vertical
Sec 3
MFD
• Fast/Slow Indicator Speed
• Flight Director Command Bars • TAS Airspeed and Airspeed Units
Avoidance
• Traffic and Terrain Annunciations
Hazard
• GPSS Annunciation
Sec 4
• Knob Mode Annunciation •
Vertical Course Deviation
Indicator and Glideslope
• Marker Beacon Annunciation
Additional
Features
Annunciation
Sec 5
• NAV Status • Wind Field
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Figure 2-18 Extreme Pitch Indication - Figure 2-19 Extreme Pitch Indication -
Sec 2
PFD
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
2.4 Altimeter
Foreword
The altimeter displays the current altitude, altitude trend, altitude bug setting,
altitude bug, and the current BARO setting.
The Altitude Trend Vector is a vertical, magenta line, extending up or down
on the left side of the Altitude scale. The end of the trend vector corresponds to
System
Sec 1
the predicted altitude in six seconds if the current vertical speed is maintained.
The Altitude Bug is displayed at the selected Altitude Bug setting. A portion
of the Altitude Bug will be displayed at the top or the bottom of the altitude tape
Sec 2
PFD
if the selected Altitude Bug is off of the tape.
When an optional Radar Altimeter is installed, the altitude received from the
radar altitude will be displayed on the PFD. See the Radar Altimeter section for
Sec 3
MFD
more details.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
1. Press the ALT key to activate Altitude mode.
2. Turn the PFD knob to move the Altitude Bug to a desired altitude.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
OR
3. Press the center of the PFD knob to set the selected altitude to the current
altitude.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Selected
Altitude
Selected in the
Symbols
Altitude Altitude
Sec 7
Bug Alerter
window
Altitude
Glossary
Sec 8
Trend Current
Indicator Altitude
Appendix A
Barometric
Index
Setting
Figure 2-21 Altimeter
alerts (if interfaced to an audio panel) when approaching the Selected Altitude.
Whenever the Selected Altitude is changed, the Altitude Alerter is reset.
NOTE: The Altitude Alerter function may be disabled in some installations.
System
Sec 1
When the Altitude Alerter is disabled, pressing the ALT key will result in
an "ALT KEY INOP" message.
• Upon passing through 1,000 feet of the Selected Altitude, the Selected
Altitude (shown above the Altimeter) changes to black text on a light blue
background, and flashes for five seconds. An audio alert may be generated,
Sec 3
MFD
if configured.
• When the aircraft passes within 200 feet of the Selected Altitude, the Selected
Altitude changes to light blue text on a black background and flashes for
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
changes to yellow text on a black background, flashes for five seconds, and
Sec 5
NOTE: The aural tone when approaching the selected altitude may be
Sec 7
configured at installation for either 200 feet or 1,000 feet. The tone when
deviating from the selected altitude always occurs at 200 feet.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
Barometric pressure units may be displayed as either inches (in) or hectopascals
(hpa). For more details, refer to System Display Units in section 3.
1. Press the BARO key to activate Baro mode.
System
Sec 1
2. Turn the PFD knob to increase or decrease the altimeter setting.
OR
3. Press the PFD knob while in Baro mode to toggle between Standard Pressure
Sec 2
PFD
(29.92 in) and the currently selected barometric setting.
PFD Knob Selected Baro Setting shown
Baro Setting in Altimeter window
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Figure 2-23 Barometric Setting
Hazard
Sec 4
Baro-Corrected Altitude Versus GPS-MSL Altitude
Baro-corrected altitude (or indicated altitude) is derived by adjusting the
Additional
Features
Sec 5
altimeter setting for local atmospheric conditions. The most accurate baro-
corrected altitude can be achieved by frequently updating the altimeter setting
to the nearest reporting station along the flight path. However, because actual
& Alerts
Annun.
atmospheric conditions seldom match the standard conditions defined by the
Sec 6
International Standard Atmosphere (ISA) model (where pressure, temperature,
and lapse rates have fixed values), it is common for the baro-corrected altitude
(as read from the altimeter) to differ from the GPS-MSL altitude. This variation
Symbols
Sec 7
results in the aircraft’s true altitude differing from the baro-corrected altitude.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
NOTE: The Altitude Minimums Alerting Bug appears parked at the bottom
PFD
of the altitude tape as soon as a value is set in the minimums alerter. The
bug will unpark and start to move up the tape as soon as the altitude is
within the range of the tape. The bug is reset when power is cycled.
Sec 3
MFD
altitude setting, the Minimums box appears with the altitude value in cyan
Sec 4
text. Once in range, the Altitude Minimums Bug appears in cyan on the
altitude tape.
Additional
Features
• When the aircraft is within 100 feet of the selected altitude setting, the bug
Sec 5
alert is made one time. The text remains in yellow until the aircraft altitude
is more than 50 feet above the set altitude minimum value.
Yellow When
Symbols
Sec 7
Barometric
Minimums
Bug
Appendix A
Barometric
Minimums
Box
Figure 2-24 Barometric MDA/DH - Alerting Visual Annunciations
Index
Yellow When
Cyan Within 2500 ft White Within 100 ft Altitude Reached
Foreword
Radar
Altimeter
Minimums
System
Sec 1
Bug
Radar
Altimeter
Minimums
Sec 2
PFD
Box
Figure 2-25 Radar Altimeter - Alerting Visual Annunciations
Alerting is inhibited while the aircraft is on the ground and until the aircraft
Sec 3
MFD
reaches 150 feet above the selected Minimum Altitude. Normally the altitude
alerter only allows selection of altitudes in 100 foot increments. When a value
other than 100 feet is set for Baro Mins, it becomes a selectable value in the
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
altitude alerter. In dual installations, the minimums alerting altitude value may
be set from either GDU 620 and will be synchronized on both units.
Setting the Altitude Minimums Bug is performed on either the FPL - Active
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Flight Plan page or the FPL - Charts page.
For information about setting the Altitude Minimums Bug on the Active
Flight Plan page, refer to section 3 - MFD - Flight Plan Pages.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
For information about setting the Altitude Minimums Bug on the Charts
page, refer to section 5 - Additional Features - Charts Menu Selections.
Symbols
NOTE: If you highlight the minimums Altitude field and press the CLR key,
Sec 7
Vertical speed (V/S) data is presented on the bottom right of the PFD. A
Vertical Speed bug and a bug setting are also available.
Max Vertical Speed
System
Sec 1
The Vertical Speed Indicator (VSI) displays the aircraft vertical speed using
Hazard
Sec 4
a non-moving tape. The tape can be scaled at ±2000, ±3000, or ±4000 fpm as
set by the installer. Major gradations are every 1000 fpm and minor gradations
every 500 fpm. The current vertical speed is displayed in the pointer along the
Additional
Features
Sec 5
tape. Digits appear in the pointer when the climb or descent rate is greater than
100 fpm. If the rate of ascent/descent exceeds the vertical speed displayed on
the tape, the pointer appears at the corresponding edge of the tape and the rate
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
appears inside the pointer. The Vertical Speed Indicator range determines the
airspeed tape range and altitude tape range.
Symbols
3. Press the center of the PFD knob to set the Vertical Speed value to the current
vertical speed.
Foreword
The Horizontal Situation Indicator (HSI) displays a rotating compass card in
a heading-up orientation. Letters indicate the cardinal points and numeric labels
occur every 30º. Major tick marks are at 10º intervals and minor tick marks at
System
5º intervals. A digital reading of the current heading appears on top of the HSI,
Sec 1
and the current ground track is represented on the HSI by a magenta diamond.
The HSI also presents turn rate, course deviation, bearing, and navigation
source information. The “MSG” annunciation will be shown in the HSI when
Sec 2
PFD
an unacknowledged message is present on the selected navigator. When the
message is acknowledged, the “MSG” annunciation will clear.
13 14 15
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
1
Hazard
Sec 4
12
2
3 11
Additional
Features
Sec 5
4 10
5
9
6
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
7
8
16
Symbols
Sec 7
The 360º HSI contains a Course Deviation Indicator (CDI), with a Course
Pointer, To/From Indicator, and a sliding deviation bar and scale. The course
Foreword
pointer is a single line arrow (GPS1, VOR1, and LOC1) or a double line arrow
(GPS2, VOR2, and LOC2) which points in the direction of the set course. “LOC”
will automatically be displayed if a localizer frequency is tuned. The To/From
System
arrow rotates with the course pointer and is displayed when the active NAVAID
Sec 1
is received.
The Selected Heading is shown to the upper left of the HSI for 10 seconds
after being adjusted. The light blue bug on the compass rose corresponds to the
Selected Heading.
Sec 3
MFD
NOTE: The current heading will have a "T" to the right of the heading
value when the Nav Angle is set to True in the System Setup page of the
Avoidance
Current Heading
(Magnetic North)
Additional
(Magnetic North)
Current Heading
(True north)
New Heading Bug Setting
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
(True North)
1. Press the PFD knob in HDG mode to set the Heading Bug to the current
heading.
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
Tick marks to the left and right of the lubber line denote half-standard and
standard turn rates. A magenta Turn Rate Trend Vector shows the current turn
rate. The end of the trend vector gives the heading predicted in six seconds,
System
Sec 1
based on the present turn rate. A standard-rate turn is shown on the indicator
by the trend vector stopping at the standard turn rate tick mark, corresponding
to a predicted heading of 18º from the current heading. At rates greater than
Sec 2
4 degrees per second, an arrowhead appears at the end of the magenta trend
PFD
vector and the prediction is no longer valid.
Sec 3
Turn Rate indication.
MFD
Arrowhead shown for
Standard Turn Rate a Turn Rate > 4 degrees
Heading Bug per second
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Half Standard Lubber Line
Turn Rate Current Track Indicator
Additional
Figure 2-29 Turn Rate Indicator and Trend Vector
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
The Course Deviation Indicator (CDI) moves left or right from the course
pointer along a lateral deviation scale to display aircraft position relative to the
course. If the course deviation data is not valid, the CDI is not displayed.
System
Sec 1
360º HSI
GPS Level
Sec 2
of Service
PFD
Navigation
Source Scale
Sec 3
MFD
Crosstrack
Error CDI
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
NOTE: The ILS Localizer and Glideslope deviation indicators will indicate
full-scale deflection for the GNS 480 navigator at the second dot. The
GNS 400W/500W series navigators will indicate full-scale deflection at
the edge of the display.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
The CDI can display two sources of navigation: GPS or NAV (VOR, and LOC).
Sec 7
Color indicates the current navigation source: magenta (for GPS) or green (for
VOR and LOC). The full-scale limits for the CDI are defined by a GPS-derived
distance when coupled to GPS. When coupled to a VOR or localizer (LOC), the
Glossary
Sec 8
CDI has the same angular limits as a mechanical CDI. If the CDI exceeds the
maximum deviation on the scale (two dots) while coupled to GPS, the crosstrack
Appendix A
Foreword
System
Sec 1
GPS VLOC
Navigator 1 Navigator 1
Sec 2
PFD
GPS VLOC
Sec 3
MFD
Navigator 2 Navigator 2
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 2-31 CDI Navigation Sources
& Alerts
1. Press the CDI soft key to toggle between GPS and VOR/LOC source type.
Annun.
Sec 6
2. Press 1-2 soft key to toggle between the 1 and 2 navigators of the GPS or VOR/
LOC sources.
Symbols
Sec 7
3. Verify the navigation source by the indication on the HSI and in the upper left
corner of the PFD.
Glossary
NOTE: The selected navigator is the active navigator for all PFD and MFD
Sec 8
being adjusted.
1. Press the PFD knob to set a Course that will center the CDI to the VOR station
or waypoint if in GPS OBS mode.
Avoidance
Foreword
an approach of this type is loaded into the flight plan and GPS is the selected
navigation source, the Vertical Deviation Indicator appears as a magenta
diamond. If the approach type downgrades to LNAV past the final approach fix
System
(FAF), or the approach only supports LNAV service, “NO GP” is annunciated.
Sec 1
Vertical Deviation Source
Sec 2
PFD
Vertical Deviation Indicator
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Figure 2-34 Vertical Deviation Indicator (GPS Source)
Hazard
Sec 4
2.7.4 Auto-Slewing
The G500/G600 system is designed to interface with GPS navigator units
Additional
Features
Sec 5
and also manage up to four different CDI course pointers (GPS1, NAV1, GPS2,
NAV2) independently. The G500/G600 will automatically slew the NAV course
pointer to the correct final approach course when a ILS, LOC, LOC BC, LDA or
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
SDF approach is active in the GPS navigator and the appropriate frequency is
in the active window in the navigator. The G500/G600 will Auto-Slew the HSI
course pointer for an ILS, LOC, LOC BC, LDA, or SDF approach when the steps
Symbols
1. The desired approach is selected and activated in the navigator (this can be
verified by the approach waypoints appearing on the GDU 620 MFD Nav Map
Glossary
3. The CDI selection on the GDU 620 is changed to NAV course pointer for the
active navigator.
Index
NOTE: If the NAV course pointer is displayed for the active navigator
when the approach is activated and the localizer frequency is tuned, the
Foreword
pilot will need to switch to another CDI source and then back to NAV
for the course pointer to Auto-Slew.
NOTE: For LOC BC approaches, the course pointer will slew 180 degrees
from the inbound course.
Sec 3
MFD
1. The aircraft is flying vectors to final on an active ILS approach, with the
appropriate approach in the GPS navigator.
Foreword
2. The appropriate ILS frequency must be activate in the navigator.
3. Verify that the waypoints for the approach are displayed on the Nav Map Page
or the FPL Page of the MFD.
System
Sec 1
4. Upon approaching the final course, select LOC on the HSI.
NOTE: If auto CDI switching is active on the GPS unit, the GPS will force
Sec 2
PFD
the GPS/GDU 620 to NAV when the aircraft is close to the LOC course.
5. The CDI and course pointer will change from magenta to green and the pointer
Sec 3
MFD
will move, or slew, to the final approach course (or 180° from the final approach
course for LOC BC approaches).
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Course Pointer slewed to
313° for the Backcourse
to Runway 13
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
also displayed.
The Bearing Information windows are displayed to the lower sides of the HSI
Sec 3
MFD
and show:
• Bearing source (GPS, NAV, or ADF)
Avoidance
• ADF is selected and a signal is not received (if you have an ADF that supports
Annun.
Sec 6
a valid flag then the bearing pointer will be removed. If your ADF system
does not include a valid flag then the bearing pointer will still be displayed,
regardless of ADF signal validity.)
Symbols
Sec 7
Bearing 2 Pointer
Glossary
GPS Level
Sec 8
Bearing 1 Source
Bearing 2 Source
Bearing 1 Bearing 2
Pointer Icon Pointer Icon
Index
OCN
ENR
TERM
Foreword
APR
LNAV
GPS1 LNAV+V
GPS2 LPV
VOR1 LNAV/VNAV
System
Sec 1
VOR2 LP
LOC1 CDI Source GPS Mode
LP+V
LOC2 1.00nm
0.30nm
MSG GPS Advisory Suspend
Sec 2
OBS
PFD
LOI LOI SUSP
Sec 3
MFD
Figure 2-38 PFD HSI Annunciations
Avoidance
1. Press the PFD soft key to display the navigation source keys.
Hazard
Sec 4
2. Press the BRG 1 or BRG 2 soft keys to toggle between the available Nav
receivers of the selected source (such as: GPS, NAV, or ADF).
Additional
Features
Sec 5
NOTE: The Bearing Line for navigation source 1 (BRG1) will be a single line.
The Bearing Line for navigation source 2 (BRG2) will be a double line.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
2.8.2 Temperature Display
The outside air temperature is displayed to the left of the HSI. The air
data computer calculates the temperature based on temperature probe and
Symbols
Pitot-static inputs. The units (°C or °F) and temperature reference are selected
Sec 7
on the AUX – SYSTEM SETUP page. The temperature reference can be selected
to one of the following choices:
• Static Air Temperature (SAT) – This is the calculated temperature of the
Glossary
Sec 8
outside air as it moves past the aircraft, including the rise in temperature
due to air compression and friction at the current airspeed.
• Difference from International Standard Atmosphere (ISA) – This is the
difference between SAT and standard (ISA) temperature at the current
Index
PFD to the left of the HSI. The Wind Vector style is configured in the Aux Mode
PFD
System Setup page. While on the ground, the Wind Vector window will indicate
“No Wind Data.”
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
corner of the PFD. The distance to the station and the Nav source used are
shown.
DME Information DME Hold Annunciation
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Foreword
the aircraft flies over a marker beacon. The marker beacon annunciation will
appear to the left of the altitude tape below the terrain annunciator on the PFD.
System
Sec 1
Outer Marker
Beacon Indication
Sec 2
PFD
Figure 2-43 Marker Beacon Location
Sec 3
MFD
Current Beacon Icon (Standard) Icon (Blink)
Inner Marker
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Middle Marker
Outer Marker
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Table 2-2 Marker Beacons
Messages will appear in the MFD alerts window if monitors are enabled and
Sec 7
reported by GDU 1 and GDU 2 exceeds the threshold described in the following
Sec 8
displayed over the pitch ladder if a miscompare condition exists for roll and
Sec 4
Airspeed Altitude
Miscompare Miscompare
Symbols
Sec 7
Foreword
When an optional Radar Altimeter is installed, the altitude received from the
radar altitude will be displayed on the PFD.
NOTE: See the Radar Altimeter documentation for details on the radar
System
Sec 1
altimeter performance and limitations.
Barometric Altitude
Sec 2
PFD
150 Feet Above Ground
Sec 3
MFD
Brown Band Indicating Ground
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Radar Altimeter Value
Figure 2-45 Radar Altimeter Display - 150 ft RA Altitude
Additional
Features
When the radar altitude is 0, the brown band will be level with the altitude
Sec 5
tape pointer. As the radar altitude increases above 0, the brown band will move
down the tape in an amount equal to the current radar altitude.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Barometric Altitude
0 Foot Difference
(On Ground)
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
The Radar Altimeter self-test process will be annunciated on the PFD above
the Radar Altimeter altitude value. The self-test is a wiring test to indicate
Index
communication between the GDU and the Radar Altimeter. The self-test will be
cancelled after 15 seconds, the Test key is pressed again, or you leave the System
Setup page.
190-00601-02 Rev. J Garmin G500/G600 Pilot’s Guide 2-33
Cover TOC
1. Turn the large MFD knob to Aux mode and then turn the small MFD knob to
the System Setup page.
2. Press the RA TEST soft key. "RA TEST" will be annunciated above the Radar
System
Sec 1
Altimeter value. The Radar Altimeter value will show a certain number to
indicate that communication is taking place between the Radar Altimeter and
the GDU. See your Radar Altimeter documentation for the appropriate value.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
4. If the unit fails the self-test, the RA value will not match the expected value. The
Hazard
Sec 4
"RA FAIL" annunciation will appear on the PFD when the GDU is not receiving
any Radar Altimeter data. "RA FAIL" is not related to the self-test.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Depending on the installation, the pilot will have one of the following
options: BARO or RAD ALT minimums altitude alert (pilot selectable).
Symbols
• The pilot can select alerts ON or OFF and can select the alert altitude
based on either barometric or radar altitude.
Glossary
• The alert upon descending through the selected altitude is the aural
Sec 8
altitude.
Index
Foreword
The Fast/Slow indication as provided from an external system is shown on
the left side of the PFD along the horizon line. See your AFM for details on
operation.
System
Sec 1
Pointer
Sec 2
PFD
Fast/Slow Scale
Sec 3
MFD
Figure 2-49 Fast/Slow Scale and Pointer
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
2.11 PFD Display Units
Additional
Features
Sec 5
The PFD display units may be set to standard or metric units by the installer.
The MFD display units may still be selected by the user in the System Setup page
of Aux mode.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
2-36
Cover
TOC
190-00601-02 Rev. J
TOC Cover
3 MULTI-FUNCTION DISPLAY
The Multi-Function Display (MFD) presents a color moving map with
Foreword
navigation information. Moving map information is shown on the two Navigation
Map pages and the optional Weather (WX) pages. The Navigation Map displays
aviation data (e.g., airports, VORs, airways, airspaces), geographic data (e.g.,
System
Sec 1
cities, lake, highways, borders), topographic data (map shading indicating
elevation), and hazard data (e.g., traffic, terrain, weather). The map options
set for Navigation Map page 1 are used as the default settings for the optional
Weather (WX) pages. Which data is displayed can be controlled by the
Sec 2
PFD
DCLTR soft key and map page MENU selections. The Navigation Map can
be oriented four different ways: North Up (NORTH UP), Track Up (TRACK
UP), Desired Track Up (DTK UP), or Heading Up (HDG UP).
Sec 3
MFD
Map Orientation
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Terrain and
Obstacles Symbols
Range Select
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Page Group Position
Menu
Page Group
Clear
Page Label
Symbols
Enter
Sec 7
being flown is shown as a magenta line on the navigation map. The other
legs are shown in white.
There are map ranges available, from 500 feet to 500 NM. The range
is now indicated in the box on the range ring at the 11 o-clock position
Foreword
relative to the ownship. To change the map range on any map, press the
RNG keys on the right side of the bezel.
3.1 Navigation Map Pages
System
Sec 1
Map displays are used extensively in the GDU 620 to provide situational
awareness in flight. The following information can be displayed on the
Navigation Map Pages:
Sec 2
PFD
with names
• Map Pointer information (distance • Topography scale
and bearing to pointer, location of • Topography data
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
• XM Storm Cells
Sec 5
• Top of Climb
• Aircraft icon (representing present
position) • Terrain data (includes terrain,
obstacles, and power lines)
Symbols
Sec 7
For details about the symbols used on the MFD, refer to section 7.
NOTE: Page Group and Page are shown at the bottom of the MFD.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Weather Source
Map Orientation
Foreword
WX Data Window
Terrain Data
System
Sec 1
Obstacle Icon.
Traffic Icons * Indicates Grouped
with Relative Obstacles.
Sec 2
Altitude and Trend
PFD
Indicator Elevation Window
Aircraft Symbol
(Present Position)
Topo Data Scale
Sec 3
MFD
Enhanced
Range Ring Current Altitude
Avoidance
Map Overlay Icons
Hazard
Sec 4
Page Name Page Location
Additional
Features
Sec 5
3.1.1 Default Navigation Map Page
While on any page of the MFD, you may easily return to the first Navigation
Map page of the Map group by pressing and holding the CLR key to return
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
to the first page (Home Page) of the Map group.
map pages. The icons are shown in the following figure. If the icon is not
displayed, either the menu selection is not ON to display the data or the
display range makes the data ineligible for display. If the icon has a white X
Glossary
Sec 8
over it then the data is selected ON and the zoom scale is correct, but the
underlying data is not available for some reason. All of the icons may not be
displayed at the same time. In some cases if one feature is selected, another
Appendix A
icon and feature may be disabled. The pilot should check the dedicated
page for the feature that the icon represents to determine why the data is not
available for display (e.g., fail, standby).
Index
Stormscope Terrain
Foreword
Traffic Obstacle
Wire Obstacle
Figure 3-4 Map Overlay Icon Samples
System
Sec 1
map display range. Pressing the RNG key will zoom out (increasing the
Features
Sec 5
displayed map range) and pressing the RNG key will zoom in (decreasing
the displayed map range). The Map Range is shown on the outer range ring. The
map ranges available are from 250 feet to 500 NM.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
1. There are four levels of decluttering. DCLTR (0) shows the most detail. DCLTR-3
removes the most detail.
Foreword
2. While viewing one of the Navigation Map pages, press the DCLTR soft key.
Each successive press of the DCLTR soft key will toggle through the declutter
levels. In the following table, features marked with a “•” are shown at the
System
Sec 1
indicated Declutter Level. Features shown at level 0 will be displayed at all
Declutter levels.
Sec 2
NOTE: Traffic is automatically decluttered from Nav Map pages when the
PFD
map scale is above 40 NM.
Sec 3
MFD
Feature 0 1 2 3 Feature 0 1 2 3
Airways • Intersections • •
Avoidance
Land/Country Text • Tower • •
Hazard
Sec 4
Large City • TRSA • •
Medium City • ADIZ • •
Additional
Features
Small City • Alert Areas • •
Sec 5
Small Town • Caution Areas • •
Freeways • Danger Areas • •
& Alerts
Annun.
Highways • Warning Areas • •
Sec 6
Roads • Large Airports • • •
Railroads • Medium Airports • • •
Symbols
3.1.6 Panning
The Panning Map Page function allows you to move the map beyond its
Foreword
current limits without adjusting the map scale and to examine information at
the pointer location. When you select the panning function — by pressing the
small MFD knob — a target pointer flashes on the map display. A window also
appears at the top of the map display showing the latitude/longitude position of
System
Sec 1
the pointer, the ETE from your present position to the pointer, elevation at the
pointer, and bearing and distance to the pointer from your present position.
Information is
Sec 2
PFD
Map Pointer
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Present Position
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
2. Turn the large MFD knob to move the cursor horizontally. Turn the small MFD
knob to move the cursor vertically.
3. Press the small MFD knob again to cancel panning. The display will return to
the previous map view.
Index
Foreword
highlighted (even if the name wasn’t originally displayed on the map). This
feature applies to airports, NAVAIDs, user-created waypoints, roads, lakes,
rivers — just about everything displayed on the map except route lines. When
System
Sec 1
an airport, NAVAID, or user waypoint is selected on the map display, you can
review information about the item.
1. While viewing the Navigation Map pages of the Map page group, press the
small MFD knob to activate panning.
Sec 2
PFD
2. Move the cursor with the small and large MFD knobs to highlight a feature.
3. Press ENT to display information about the highlighted feature.
Sec 3
MFD
4. Press one of the soft keys for details of the selected topic.
5. Press the small MFD knob again to return to panning.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
3.1.8 Measuring Distances
The “Measure Bearing/Distance” function provides a quick and easy method to
Additional
Features
determine the bearing and distance between any two points on the Navigation Map.
Sec 5
1. While viewing one of the Navigation Map pages of the Map page group, press
MENU.
2. Turn the large or small MFD knobs to highlight “Measure Bearing/
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Distance“ and then press ENT. Symbols
Sec 7
3. Your present position will be marked as the starting reference point. To choose
a different starting reference point, turn the large or small MFD knobs to
desired point and press ENT.
Appendix A
4. Turn the large or small MFD knobs to move the cursor to a reference point. The
distance and bearing is displayed at the top of the display.
Point position
System
Sec 1
The Navigation Map pages are customized by selecting options from the Page
Sec 5
Menu. The Page Menu options include choices for Map Setup and Measure
Bearing/Distance. The Map Setup choice covers selections for Map, Weather,
Traffic, and Aviation depending on the installed equipment of a given aircraft.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
2. With the cursor flashing on the “Map Setup” option. Press the ENT key to
display the Map Setup Menu.
Foreword
3. Use the large and small MFD knobs to select the Group and press ENT to
allow editing of the selected group. The groups shown depend on the features
available for equipment installed in your aircraft.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Figure 3-12 Navigation Map Page Menu Map Group Selection
4. Press the small MFD knob to return to the Navigation Map Page.
Sec 3
MFD
Map Group Weather Group Traffic Group Aviation Group
(optional) (optional)
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Menu Settings Menu Settings Menu Adjustment Menu Settings
Item Item Item Item
Orientation North Up NEXRAD Off/Range Traffic Off Safe Taxi Off/Range
Track Up Viewing All Traffic Viewing
Additional
Features
DTK Up Range TA/PA Range
Sec 5
HDG Up TA Only
North Up Off/Range NEXRAD Off/Range Rwy Off/Range
At Cell Mov Extension
Range
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Auto Zoom On/Off NEXRAD On/Off INT/NDB Off/Range
Legend Viewing
Range *
Symbols
Range
Topo Scale On/Off PRECOP On/Off MOA Off/Range
Legend (Military)*
Terrain On/Off DL LTNG Off/Range Other/ Off/Range
Sec 2
PFD
Viewing
Range
Power Line Off/Range Airways Off/Modes
Viewing
Avoidance
Hazard
Range
Sec 4
View** Airspaces
Selected On/Off Airspace On/Off
Alt Range Labels
Arc
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
VRP Off/Range
Viewing
Range
Symbols
active, turn the large MFD knob to highlight the desired option.
2. Turn the small MFD knob to change the highlighted value.
3. Press ENT to accept the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
4. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
Foreword
the Navigation Map page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Map Orientation
The Orientation option sets the orientation of the Navigation Map.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Figure 3-13 Navigation Map Orientation
North Up At
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
The North Up At option allows you to select the map range where at and
above the selected value the Map Orientation will automatically change to North
Up. For example, with the 500 NM value selected and the map range of the MFD
Additional
Features
Sec 5
is 500 NM or more, the map orientation will automatically become North Up.
Auto Zoom
With a valid flight plan, the Auto Zoom feature will automatically change the
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Navigation Map range depending on the distance to the next waypoint in the
flight plan. If enabled, it will also automatically zoom to the SafeTaxi zoom range
when the aircraft is on the ground. Auto Zoom can be overridden at any time
Symbols
Sec 7
by manually zooming with the RNG keys or enabling OBS mode. Auto Zoom is
re-enabled during any one of the following conditions:
• The active waypoint changes during flight.
Glossary
Sec 8
Land Data
The Land Data option selects whether detailed land features, such as rivers,
roads, cities, are displayed. Topo features, traffic, terrain, and obstacles will still
Index
and arrow extending from the aircraft icon illustrating the current Track and the
distance the aircraft will travel in the selected time.
System
Sec 1
Track Vector
Sec 2
The Wind Vector option when turned on will show a box in the top right
corner of the MFD indicating the wind direction and speed.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
ring at 1/2 the distance of the primary ring to allow the pilot to accurately judge
Sec 6
Topo Data
The Topo Data option selects whether the colored topographical features are
Foreword
displayed. Traffic, Land Data, Terrain, and Obstacles will still be displayed even
with Topo Data turned off.
Topo Data Off Topo Data On
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Figure 3-17 Navigation Map Topo Data
Topo Scale
Additional
Features
The Topo Scale option selects whether the elevation scale for topographical
Sec 5
features on the Navigation Map is displayed. The scale will be located on the
right side of the display.
Minimum/Maximum
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Range of Topography
Displayed on the Map
Symbols
Sec 7
Sky Indication
Range of Topography
Displayed on the Map Current Aircraft Altitude
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Terrain Data
The Terrain Data option selects whether Terrain Data is shown on the
Foreword
Navigation Map. The Terrain Data Icon will be shown when Terrain has
been selected.
Terrain Data Off Terrain Data On
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Terrain Data
The Obstacle Data Viewing Range option selects whether the Obstacle Data
Features
Sec 5
is shown on the Navigation Map. Obstacles will be shown at and below the
selected map range. Map ranges above this value will not show the Obstacle
Data.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Obstacle databases created for software version 7.00 or later may include
HOT lines depending on the type of obstacle database installed. Hazardous
Foreword
Obstacle Transmission (HOT) Lines are power lines that have been identified as
a potential hazard to aircraft. The installed obstacle database type can be verified
on the System Status page. Power line data is available for the contiguous United
System
States as well as small parts of Canada and Mexico.
Sec 1
Lat/Lon Viewing Range
The Lat/Lon Viewing Range option selects whether Lat/Lon line is shown on
Sec 2
the MFD.
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Lat/Lon Reference Information
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Figure 3-21 Navigation Map Lat/Lon Information
Field of View
Symbols
Sec 7
The Field of View represented by the synthetic terrain data used for the
Synthetic Vision Technology (SVT) option (when enabled) can be represented
on the MFD Navigation Map Page lateral image. Two dashed lines forming
Glossary
Sec 8
a V-shape in front of the aircraft symbol on the MFD, represent the forward
viewing area shown on the PFD.
Appendix A
Index
map to predict where the ownship will be when it reaches the altitude selected
Features
Sec 5
on the altitude alerter on the PFD. The distance from the ownship to the arc is
based on ground speed, baro altitude, selected altitude, and vertical speed. The
arc is shown when the aircraft is moving toward the selected altitude at a vertical
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Selected Altitude
Range Arc
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
NOTE: For steps on how to select a weather source, refer to
section 3.2.1.10.
The Weather group selection from the Map Setup Page Menu allows you
System
Sec 1
to customize the NEXRAD Viewing Range, NEXRAD Cell Movement, and
Lightning Viewing range. Weather is an optional feature that requires a GDL
69/69A and an XM WX Satellite Weather subscription, or other weather product
Sec 2
PFD
(such as GFDS).
1. While viewing the Navigation Map 1 or 2 page of the Map page group, press
the MENU key to display the Navigation Map Page Menu.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Figure 3-24 Navigation Map Page Menu
Additional
Features
Sec 5
2. With the cursor flashing on the “Map Setup” option, press the ENT key to
display the Map Setup Menu.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
3. Use the large and small MFD knobs to select the Weather Group and press
ENT to allow editing of the selected group. The groups shown depend on the
features available for equipment installed in your aircraft.
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
4. Press the small MFD knob to return to the Navigation Map Page.
Index
The NEXRAD Cell Movement option selects whether NEXRAD Cell Movement
is shown on the Navigation Map.
NEXRAD Legend
Sec 3
MFD
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
weather products will be shown at and below the selected map range. When
Off is selected, Lightning weather will not be shown. Where 100 NM is selected,
Appendix A
Foreword
sources for NEXRAD weather products.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Figure 3-27 NEXRAD Weather Source Selection
Stormscope Viewing Range
Avoidance
Hazard
The Stormscope Viewing Range option selects Stormscope cells or strikes are
Sec 4
shown on the Navigation Map. Products will be shown at and below the selected
map range. When Off is selected, cells or strikes will not be shown. Where
Additional
Features
100 NM is selected, symbols will be shown at map ranges of 100 NM and lower.
Sec 5
NOTE: The selected lightning display type, cell or strike, will be shown the
same on both the StormScope and the Map pages.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
NOTE: StormScope data is displayed on the Map Page only if aircraft
heading is available.
Symbols
Sec 7
heading is available, the pilot must clear the strikes after each heading
Sec 8
change.
Strike/Cell Mode
Appendix A
When the Stormscope Viewing Range option has a range greater than zero,
the Stormscope cells or strikes option is made available and can determine
which type are shown on the Navigation Map.
Index
customize the display of traffic on the Navigation Map. The Traffic function
requires the installation of a compatible traffic device.
the map scale is above 15 NM and traffic symbols will not be drawn when
the map scale is above 40 NM.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
1. While viewing the Navigation Map Setup page and the Traffic Group active,
Sec 7
the Navigation Map page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
When the Traffic overlay is active on a Map page, a Traffic icon will be
displayed on the Map page where it is selected.
Index
Traffic Overlay
Foreword
Selected Icon
Traffic Overlay
Smart Key Label
Figure 3-29 Navigation Map Traffic Overlay
System
Sec 1
3.1.10.4 Aviation Feature Options
The Aviation group selection from the Map Setup Page Menu allows you to
customize the display of SafeTaxi information, Runway Extensions, Intersection/
Sec 2
NDB locations, VOR locations, and TFR icons on the Navigation Map.
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Figure 3-30 Navigation Map Page Menu Aviation Group Selection
SafeTaxi Viewing Range
Additional
Features
Sec 5
The SafeTaxi viewing range option selects the range at which SafeTaxi
information is shown on the Navigation Map. SafeTaxi will be shown at and
below the selected map range. When Off is selected, SafeTaxi information will
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
not be shown. Where 1 NM is selected, the SafeTaxi information will be shown
at map ranges of 1 NM and lower.
Runway Extension Range
Symbols
Sec 7
The Runway Extension Range option selects the whether Runway Extensions
is shown for the flight plan destination airport runway and will extend 10 NM.
Glossary
Runway Extensions will be shown at and below the selected map range. When
Sec 8
on the Navigation Map. VOR information will be shown at and below the
selected map range. When Off is selected, the information will not be shown.
Where 150 NM is selected, VOR information will be shown at map ranges of
Sec 3
MFD
The Class B/TMA airspace viewing range option selects whether Class B/TMA
Hazard
Sec 4
selected, the information will not be shown. Where 100 NM is selected, Class B/
Features
Sec 5
TMA airspace information will be shown at map ranges of 100 NM and lower.
Class C/TCA Airspace Viewing Range
& Alerts
Annun.
The Class C/TCA airspace viewing range option selects whether Class C/TCA
Sec 6
selected, the information will not be shown. Where 100 NM is selected, Class
Sec 7
C/TCA airspace information will be shown at map ranges of 100 NM and lower.
Class D Airspace Viewing Range
Glossary
Sec 8
The Class D airspace viewing range option selects whether Class D airspace
information is shown on the Navigation Map. Class D airspace information
will be shown at and below the selected map range. When Off is selected, the
Appendix A
Foreword
is shown on the Navigation Map. Restricted airspace information will be shown
at and below the selected map range. When Off is selected, the information will
not be shown. Where 100 NM is selected, Restricted airspace information will
System
Sec 1
be shown at map ranges of 100 NM and lower.
MOA (Military) Viewing Range
The MOA (Military) viewing range option selects whether MOA (Military)
Sec 2
PFD
information is shown on the Navigation Map. MOA airspace information will
be shown at and below the selected map range. When Off is selected, the
information will not be shown. Where 100 NM is selected, MOA airspace
Sec 3
MFD
information will be shown at map ranges of 100 NM and lower.
Other/ADIZ Airspace Viewing Range
Avoidance
The Other/ADIZ airspace viewing range option selects whether Other/ADIZ
Hazard
Sec 4
airspace information is shown on the Navigation Map. Other/ADIZ airspace
information will be shown at and below the selected map range. When Off is
Additional
selected, the information will not be shown. Where 100 NM is selected, Other/
Features
Sec 5
ADIZ airspace information will be shown at map ranges of 100 NM and lower.
TFR Viewing Range (optional)
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
The Temporary Flight Restriction (TFR) viewing range option selects
whether TFR information is shown on the Navigation Map. TFR information
will be shown at and below the selected map range. When Off is selected, the
Symbols
Sec 7
information will not be shown. Where 100 NM is selected, TFR information will
be shown at map ranges of 100 NM and lower. This optional feature requires
an active data link receiver. TFRs are provided through the datalink. Some TFRs
Glossary
may exist that are not available to the datalink provider and as such will not be
Sec 8
displayed.
Airways
Appendix A
The Airways option allows you to select the airways that are shown on the
Navigation Map. All, Low only, and Hi only Airways may be selected. When Off
is selected, airways will not be shown.
Index
Smart Airspace
The Smart Airspaces selection filters airspaces to show the ones appropriate for
Foreword
your altitude. Garmin’s Smart Airspace™ feature aids visual clarity on-screen by
de-emphasizing airspace that’s well above or below the aircraft’s current altitude.
The vertical separation is 1,000 feet at sea level and the vertical separation will
System
gradually increase to 2,000 feet until the aircraft reaches 10,000 feet. Anything
Sec 1
NOTE: Smart Airspace only changes the depiction of the airspace on the
Sec 2
PFD
moving map display. It does not alter the Airspace Alerts that can be set
on the System-Alerts portion of the system.
Smart Airspaces - De-Emphasized Smart Airspaces - Emphasized (On
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 3-31 Display of Smart Airspaces (Airspace Borders Grayed When Emphasized)
Show Airspace
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
The Airspace viewing range options select whether the Airspaces are shown
on the Map and at and below the selected map ranges.
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Airspace Labels
The Airspace Label feature shows the airspace altitude limits within the
Foreword
selected range.
System
Sec 1
Airspace Labels
Sec 2
PFD
Figure 3-33 Airspace Labels
Sec 3
MFD
Visual Reporting Points
The Visual Reporting Points (VRPs) viewing range option selects whether VRP
Avoidance
information is shown on the Navigation Map. VRP information will be shown
Hazard
Sec 4
at and below the selected map range. When Off is selected, the information will
not be shown. Where 15 NM is selected, the VRPs will be shown for map ranges
Additional
at and below 15 NM.
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Map Display
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
4. Turn the large or small MFD knobs to highlight the Video selection and then
Sec 8
press ENT.
Appendix A
Foreword
and system Status.
3.2.1 System Settings
G500/G600 system settings are managed from the Aux Mode System Setup
System
Sec 1
Page. The following settings can be changed:
• Display Brightness (Mode and Level)
• Airspeeds (Glide-REF, VR, VX - V1, and VY - V2)
Sec 2
PFD
• PFD Options (Wind Vector, Nav Status Styles, and Temp Reference)
• Dual Unit Synchronization (CDI, Baro, and some Databases)
• Date/Time (Date, Time, Time Format, and Time Offset)
Sec 3
MFD
• MFD Display Units (Distance/Speed and Altitude/Vertical Speed)
• System Display Units (Navigation Angle Reference, Pressure Units, and
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Temperature Units)
• Data Link (FIS, XM, GFDS)
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
The default values set by the installer during installation are restored by using
the Page Menu options or soft keys. The “Restore Unit Defaults” menu selection
Foreword
and the DFLT UNIT soft key restores the default MFD Display and System
Display Units settings. The “Restore Airspeed Defaults” menu selection or DFLT
SPD soft key restores the default PFD Airspeeds settings.
System
Sec 1
The RA TEST soft key activates the Radar Altimeter test mode. For more
details, refer to section 2.
NOTE: Not all Radar Altimeters have the TEST function.
Sec 2
PFD
1. While viewing the Aux mode System Setup page, press the MENU key.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
press ENT.
1. Turn the large MFD knob to reach the AUX page group. Press the small MFD
knob to activate the cursor.
2. The Level will be highlighted. Turn the small MFD knob to select the Display
Glossary
Sec 8
3. If the Level was changed, Manual will be selected. Press the cursor to save the
settings. If you press ENT the Mode setting will be highlighted.
4. With the Mode value highlighted, turn the small MFD knob to select Auto or
Manual and then press ENT.
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Figure 3-39 Aux Mode Display Brightness Mode Selection
3.2.1.2 Airspeed Reference Marks
The Best Glide (or REF), Vr, Vx (or V1), and Vy (or V2) airspeed reference
Sec 3
MFD
marks for the PFD are adjusted with this function. A marker will appear on the
PFD Airspeed tape at the selected speed when the value is set to “On.” Default
reference airspeeds are set during installation. When power is cycled, the values
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
you set will be reset to the default values.
NOTE: When power is cycled, the Airspeed Reference values are reset.
During preflight, the Airspeed Reference values should be checked and
Additional
Features
Sec 5
set appropriately for the current aircraft configuration and performance.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
When selected, Nav Status information is displayed on the PFD either on the
Sec 8
top of the display (Style 1) or to the left of the HSI (Style 2).
Appendix A
1. While viewing the System Setup page of the AUX page group, press the small
MFD knob to activate the cursor. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight the
desired Nav Status value.
2. Turn the small MFD knob to select the style and press ENT.
Index
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Style 1 - Top of Display
Style 2 - Left of HSI
Sec 3
MFD
Figure 3-42 Nav Status Style
3. After the Nav Status style is selected, the chosen style will be displayed on the
Avoidance
PFD.
Hazard
Sec 4
NOTE: Nav Status option is not available for all installations.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
3.2.1.5 Temperature Reference
The computer calculates the temperature based on temperature probe and
Pitot-static inputs. The units (°C or °F) and temperature reference are selected
on the AUX – SYSTEM SETUP page. The temperature reference can be selected
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
to one of the following choices:
• Static Air Temperature (SAT) – This is the calculated temperature of the
stationary (static) outside air. Conceptually, this is the temperature that
Symbols
Sec 7
1. While viewing the System Setup page of the AUX page group, press the small
MFD knob to activate the cursor. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight the
Foreword
Dual GDU 620 units when connected in the aircraft may be set up to
communicate and share information by “Crossfilling” or synchronizing
Avoidance
Hazard
information between the two units. A single GDU 620 may be set up to
Sec 4
System Setup page of the Aux page group. Database Synchronization is managed
Sec 5
in the DB Sync function on the System Status page of the Aux page group.
1. While viewing the first page of the AUX page group, press the small MFD knob
& Alerts
Annun.
and turn the large MFD knob to highlight “CDI,” “BARO,” “Databases,” or
Sec 6
Foreword
• Selected Altitude
• Selected Heading
• Selected Course
System
Sec 1
• Selected Vertical Speed
• Airspeed Bug Values
Sec 2
PFD
• Airspeed Color Band Values
• System Pressure Units
• System Temperature Units
Sec 3
MFD
The following information can be synchronized between GDU 620s, or
changed independently, depending on the Crossfill Synchronization Settings:
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
• Barometric Correction (default ON)
• Selected CDI (default OFF)
Additional
Features
When Barometric Correction is synchronized, any changes to the Barometric
Sec 5
Setting on either GDU will change it on both GDUs.
When the CDI is synchronized, any changes to the selected CDI on either
& Alerts
Annun.
GDU will change it on both GDUs. Either pilot can change the OBS course on
Sec 6
either GPS. If the pilot selects GPS1 on the CDI and GPS1 is in OBS mode, any
course changes will move the OBS on GPS1, GDU1, and GDU2 (if the copilot
has GPS1 displayed on the CDI). Similarly, if the pilot selects GPS2 on the CDI
Symbols
Sec 7
and GPS2 is in OBS mode, any course changes will move the OBS on GPS2,
GDU1, and GDU2 (if the copilot has GPS2 displayed on the CDI).
Glossary
AHRS 1 and ADC 1 will only be displayed on GDU1. AHRS2 and ADC2 will
Sec 8
navigation source. In a single GDU 620 system, the GDU CDI soft key will
change the source in the connected navigator and making a source change in the
navigator will be reflected in the GDU 620. In a dual GDU 620 system, the CDI
keys in the navigator are disabled.
Index
1. While viewing the System Setup page of the AUX page group, press the small
Symbols
Sec 7
MFD knob to activate the cursor. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight “Time
Format.”
2. Turn the small MFD knob to select Local 12hr, Local 24hr, or UTC and then
Glossary
Sec 8
press ENT. When Local 12 or 24 hour mode is selected, the Time Offset value
will then be highlighted.
Appendix A
3. Turn the small MFD knob to select the desired offset and then press ENT.
Index
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Figure 3-46 Date and Time Values
Sec 2
PFD
4. A Time Offset may be entered by using the large and small MFD knobs to
change the values. Press ENT after completing any changes.
5. Press the small MFD knob to exit adjustments.
Sec 3
MFD
3.2.1.8 MFD Display Units
The MFD Display Units options allow you to select the units of measurement
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
conventions displayed on the MFD. Distance and Speed selections are Imperial,
Metric, or Nautical. Altitude and Vertical speed selections are Feet or Meters.
Traffic information is always shown in Nautical Miles (distance) and Feet
Additional
Features
Sec 5
(altitude).
1. While viewing the System Setup page of the AUX page group, press the small
MFD knob to activate the cursor. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight the
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Distance and Speed (DIS, SPD) units of measurement. Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
2. Turn the small MFD knob to select Imperial, Metric, or Nautical and then press
ENT. The Altitude and Vertical Speed units selection will now be highlighted.
3. Turn the small MFD knob to select Feet or Meters and then press ENT.
Index
The System Display Units options allows the selection of units to display
values for Navigation Angle (Magnetic or True), Barometric Setting (inches or
Hectopascals), and Temperature (Fahrenheit or Celsius). Pressing the DFLT
Sec 3
MFD
MFD knob to activate the cursor. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight the
Hazard
Sec 4
the same type in both the GDU 620 and GPS navigators.
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
The Barometric Pressure Setting value will now be highlighted. When True is
Sec 8
selected, a "T" will appear to the right of the heading value on the PFD.
Appendix A
Index
3. Turn the small MFD knob to select the Barometric Setting units and then press
ENT. The Temperature value will now be highlighted.
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Figure 3-51 Temperature System Display Units
4. Turn the small MFD knob to select the Temperature units and then press ENT.
Sec 3
MFD
3.2.1.10 Data Link
The Data Link WX/TFR Source menu allows users to select the source of
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
weather that is displayed on the MFD. Only the options that are installed will
be displayed.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Figure 3-52 WX/TFR Source Options
Symbols
Sec 7
4. Turn the small MFD knob to select XM, GFDS, or FIS-B, and then press ENT.
5. Press the small MFD knob to exit adjustments.
Index
XM Satellite radios, service, and products when the GDL 69/69A is installed and
the Sirius XM Satellite Radio service is activated.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
when activated in the optional installation of the GDL 69A. The GDU 620 serves
as the display and control head for your remotely mounted GDL 69A. Sirius XM
Satellite Radio allows you to enjoy a variety of radio programming over long
System
Sec 1
distances without having to constantly search for new stations. Based on signal
from satellites, coverage far exceeds land-based transmissions. When enabled,
the Sirius XM Satellite Radio audio entertainment is accessible in Aux Mode.
Sec 2
PFD
The information on the Sirius XM Satellite Radio display is composed of
four areas: the Active Channel, Available Channels, Category of the highlighted
Channel, and the Volume setting. The Active Channel window shows the
Sec 3
MFD
Channel Name and Number, Artist, Song Title, and Category.
1. Turn the large MFD knob to the AUX page group.
2. Turn the small MFD knob to the XM Radio page.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
version numbers for all detected system LRUs. Pertinent information on all
system databases is also displayed. Active LRUs are indicated by green check
marks; failed LRUs by red “X’s.” Failed LRUs should be noted and a service
System
Sec 1
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
3. Press the LRU soft key to highlight the first item in the LRU Info window.
4. Turn the small MFD knob to scroll through the items in the LRU Info window
System
in case more items are available than are displayed. If more items are available
Sec 1
than can be displayed in the window, a scroll bar will show on the right side of
the window.
Sec 2
5. Press the DB ACTV soft key to display the active databases.
PFD
6. Press the DB SYNC soft key to display the status of Database SYNC operations.
The synchronization happens automatically regardless of whether the soft key
Sec 3
MFD
is used.
3.2.4.1 Database Sync Operation
Database SYNC allows the G500/G600 to synchronize databases from a
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
single unit. The pilot only needs to update a single database card and the new
databases are automatically SYNC’d through the units connected in the cockpit
and configured for Database Syncing.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
The following databases can be synchronized between using Database SYNC:
• Navigation • Chartview (when support is
• Obstacle added by Jeppesen)
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
• SafeTaxi • FliteCharts
• Airport Directory • Basemap
Symbols
Sec 7
When Database SYNC is enabled in the LRUs and a database card is inserted
that is created for Database SYNC, the G500/G600 will coordinate with the
other LRUs in the cockpit to determine which unit has the newest databases.
Glossary
Sec 8
Once the determination has occurred, the connected LRUs will begin to
transfer the databases. This process may take several minutes. Charts are meant
to be transferred while in-flight, before the new chart database is effective,
Appendix A
as this could take an hour or more. The status of the database transfers to a
unit can be viewed in the System Status function on the DB SYNC page. The
G500/G600 will display the source of the received databases. If a database transfer
is pending, completed, or not authorized, the status will also be indicated.
Index
When the transfer is complete, if there are new and current databases to
be used, and if the aircraft is stopped and has yet to take-off, the pilot will be
Foreword
prompted with the option to restart the unit that contains the new databases.
NOTE: This feature is available in SW Versions 7.00, and later.
System
Sec 1
NOTE: Restarting the G500/G600 must only be performed when the aircraft
is on the ground as navigation and communication from the restarted unit
will be lost for a period of time.
Sec 2
PFD
3. On the System Status page, press the DB SYNC soft key to view the transfer
Hazard
Sec 4
process.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Figure 3-57 Database Transfer Complete
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
is effective and the aircraft is on the ground and stopped prior to a flight, a
pop-up and confirmation will be presented to restart the unit. No pop-up will
appear if the aircraft is moving or has been in the air since the unit was turned
on.
System
Sec 1
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
WARNING: The unit will reset and all GPS navigation and moving map
Glossary
Foreword
cycle of a database, but they have different regions or types of that database
(i.e., Fixed-wing vs. Rotorcraft navigation database, different regions of the
navigation database, or different obstacle database types) then a database conflict
System
Sec 1
will occur. When a database conflict occurs, that database will not be SYNC’d
until the pilot resolves the conflict. Initiate the resolve conflicts function on the
unit that contains the databases which the pilot wishes to use. These databases
Sec 2
will then be sent to other units.
PFD
1. Press the DB SYNC soft key, and then select the Resolve Conflicts function
on the LRU with the desired databases.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
3. Once sync’d, the desired database will be SYNC’d to the other LRUs and
“Initiating” will be displayed on the Sync Conflicts window.
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
While the chart database is synchronizing in the background, the GDU will
stream individual charts to other compatible displays. This enables all Garmin
displays to use the latest chart database information even though the database
Symbols
Sec 7
is currently installed only on a single unit. Chart Streaming will not begin until
after the chart database has begun synchronizing.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
page will show the status of satellite communications, FIS-B weather products,
and the traffic applications.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Figure 3-63 ADS-B/FIS-B Status Page
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
2. The External Video page is the first page in the Aux page group.
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
If more than one video source is available, the Video 1 and Video 2 soft keys
will be available at the bottom of the display.
Appendix A
1. Press the Video 1 soft key to select Video 1 source for viewing and setup.
2. Press the Video 2 soft key to select Video 2 source for viewing and setup.
Index
3.2.6.2 Zoom
1. While viewing the External Video function, press the Up Rng Arrow key to
Foreword
increase the zoom up to 10x magnification. Zoom level is made through digital
magnification.
2. Press the Down Rng Arrow key to decrease the zoom level down to a
System
Sec 1
minimum of 1x.
3. Pressing the FULL soft key toggles between a half and full page view.
3.2.6.3 Panning
Sec 2
PFD
1. While viewing the External Video function, press the small MFD knob to
activate panning.
Sec 3
MFD
2. Turn the small MFD knob clockwise to pan up (the map will move down).
3. Turn the small MFD knob counterclockwise to pan down (the map will move
up).
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
4. Turn the large MFD knob clockwise to pan to the right (the map will move left).
5. Turn the large MFD knob counterclockwise to pan to the left (the map will
Additional
Features
move right).
Sec 5
6. Press the small MFD knob to exit panning.
3.2.6.4 Setup
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
The display of each video source is set up individually.
1. While viewing the External Video page, press the soft key for the desired Video
source (Video 1 or Video 2).
Symbols
Sec 7
4. After selecting the desired settings, press the small MFD knob or the Setup
soft key to exit editing.
Brightness Adjustment
1. While viewing the External Video page and the desired Video source, press the
Foreword
Contrast Adjustment
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
1. While viewing the External Video page and the desired Video source, press the
Setup soft key.
2. The Current value for Brightness will be selected. Turn the large MFD knob to
Additional
Features
Sec 5
highlight the Contrast value. Turn the small MFD knob to adjust the Contrast
value.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Saturation Adjustment
1. While viewing the External Video page and the desired Video source, press the
Foreword
Setup soft key.
2. The Current value for Brightness will be selected. Turn the large MFD knob
to highlight the Saturation value. Turn the small MFD knob to adjust the
System
Sec 1
Saturation value.
Sec 2
PFD
Figure 3-68 External Video Saturation Adjustment
Sec 3
MFD
3. After selecting the desired setting, press the small MFD knob to exit editing.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
The Restore Defaults selection will return the Brightness, Contrast, and
Saturation values to their original settings.
1. While viewing the External Video page, press the MENU key.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Figure 3-69 Restore Video Defaults Menu Selection
Symbols
Sec 7
display.
1. While viewing the External Video page, press the FULL key.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Window of the
Sec 5
4. Press the small MFD knob to accept the selected display area shown in the
window.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
them over the Iridium® satellite at a given interval through the GSR 56.
3.2.7.1 Status
System
The Status window shows the time until the next data transmission and the
Sec 1
status of the reporting system.
NOTE: The GSR 56 does not report its serial number until 90 seconds after
Sec 2
power up of the GDU. As a result, for that period, the product info for the
PFD
GSR 56 will show "Waiting."
Sec 3
MFD
The Time Until Transmit field is a countdown timer that shows the time until
the next data transmission. This field is blank when the aircraft is on the ground.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Countdown Time Until Transmit
Additional
Figure 3-71 Position Reporting Time Until Transmit
Features
Sec 5
Position Reporting Status
Position Reporting will be enabled when the aircraft is in the air.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Status Description
Idle The reporting system is not using the GSR 56 for reporting at
this time.
Symbols
Sec 7
Standard
When the Standard reporting type is used, the Position Reporting Period may
be set to Off or Automatic. The Automatic Position Reporting Period can be set
Index
to intervals of 2 to 60 minutes.
1. Turn the large MFD knob to reach the Aux page group. Turn the small MFD
knob to reach the Position Reporting page.
Foreword
knob to highlight "Off" or "Automatic" and then press the ENT key. The
Position Reporting Period interval will now be selected.
5. Turn the small MFD knob to select the reporting frequency.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
7. With the Standard Reporting Type, the reporting period may be manually
overridden by pressing the SEND soft key to send data.
Appendix A
Foreword
can send position reports that contain data as required by the U.S. Government
Automated Flight Following system. The GSR 56 account will allow configuration
to forward data to the Automated Flight Following system.
System
Sec 1
1. While viewing the Position Reporting function, press the small MFD knob to
select the Report Type.
2. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight "AFF" and then press the ENT.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Figure 3-75 Select Automatic Flight Following (AFF) Reporting Type
Additional
Features
Sec 5
3. Turn the small MFD knob to select "OFF" or the default "Every 2 Min" value.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
The Status section shows the Call Time, Phone Status, and Call Suppression
selected. The Call Time value shows the length of the call time for the current
call using the Iridium phone. Phone Status shows the current operating status
of the Iridium phone.
Sec 2
PFD
Status Description
Idle The Iridium phone is not using the GSR 56 for communicating
Sec 3
MFD
at this time.
Initializing The GSR 56 and its driver are currently initializing.
Avoidance
Busy The phone is in use by another service and the call may not be
made.
& Alerts
Annun.
Unavailable The GSR 56 is currently not usable by the Iridium phone system.
Table 3-6 Iridium Phone Status
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Call Suppression controls calling when use of the Iridium phone system is
allowed.
Foreword
1. Turn the large MFD knob to reach the Aux page group. Turn the small MFD
knob to reach the Iridium Phone page.
2. Press the small MFD knob to select the Call Suppression type.
System
Sec 1
Status Description
Off Call Suppression is turned off. Calls may be transmitted and
Sec 2
PFD
received through the Iridium phone.
On Call Suppression is turned on. The incoming call pop-up will not
be shown. The call may still be answered on the phone page.
Sec 3
MFD
Outgoing calls are not affected.
On During APR/ Call Suppression is turned on during Approach, Missed Approach,
MAPR/TERM and Terminal operations. The incoming call pop-up will not
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
be shown. The call may still be answered on the phone page.
Outgoing calls are not affected.
Table 3-7 Call Suppression
Additional
Features
Sec 5
3. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired selection.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
4. Press the ENT key. Press the small MFD knob again to cancel the selection
Appendix A
cursor.
Index
will only be available for use when the SD card is in the bottom slot. The Phone
Book may hold up to 128 entries. A phone number may be entered and dialed
without saving it to the Phone Book. Note that it is necessary to dial a “1,” the
System
Sec 1
3. If items already exist in the catalog, turn the large MFD knob to select the
Phone Book Catalog icon. Then, turn the small MFD knob to display the
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
contents of the Phone Book Catalog and highlight the New Entry selection and
press ENT.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 3-78 "New Entry" Selected for Phone Book Catalog Entry
4. Turn the small MFD knob to select the first character of the name and then turn
Symbols
the large MFD knob to select the next character. When the name is complete,
Sec 7
Foreword
to select the first character of the number and then turn the large MFD knob
to select the next character. When the number is complete, press the ENT key.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Phone Book
Catalog
Entry Number
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Press To Use Keys
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
For Number Entry
Figure 3-80 Phone Book Number Entry
2. Press the small MFD knob again to cancel the selection cursor.
Symbols
Sec 7
Figure 3-82 Selecting Numeric Groups for Phone Book Number Entry
3. Press the key for the desired number. Repeat as necessary and then press ENT
when the number is complete.
Sec 2
PFD
2. Turn the small MFD knob to display the contents of the Phone Book Catalog
and highlight the desired entry.
Symbols
Sec 7
Selected Phone
Book Catalog Entry
Glossary
Sec 8
cursor.
Index
Foreword
knob to select the Phone Book Catalog icon.
2. Turn the small MFD knob to display the contents of the Phone Book Catalog
and highlight the desired entry. Press ENT to select the catalog entry.
System
Sec 1
3. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight the DELETE key. Press ENT to delete the
catalog entry. Press the small MFD knob again to cancel the selection cursor.
Sec 2
PFD
Editing a Phone Book Catalog Entry
1. Press the small MFD knob to activate the cursor and then turn the large MFD
knob to select the Phone Book Catalog icon.
Sec 3
MFD
2. Turn the small MFD knob to display the contents of the Phone Book Catalog
and highlight the desired entry. Press ENT to select the catalog entry.
Avoidance
Hazard
3. Use the large MFD and small MFD knobs to make changes to the name or
Sec 4
number. Press ENT to save the changes. Press the small MFD knob again to
cancel the selection cursor.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
3.2.8.3 Phone Volume
Use the Phone Volume controls to adjust the loudness of the phone calls
you hear. Volume controls will only be available when the Idle, Connected, or
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Changing Volume states are displayed.
Adjusting the Phone Volume with the Rotary Knobs
Symbols
Sec 7
1. While viewing the Iridium Phone page, press the small MFD knob and then
turn the large MFD knob to select the Volume control. The volume bar graph
will blink when selected.
Glossary
Sec 8
2. Turn the small MFD knob to set the desired volume level.
3. Press the ENT key. Press the small MFD knob again to cancel the selection
Appendix A
cursor.
Index
display.
Phone Volume
Level Bar Graph
System
Sec 1
2. Press the VOL + or VOL – keys as necessary to adjust the phone volume.
Sec 3
MFD
3. Pressing the ATT soft key will attenuate the volume. Press the ATT soft key
again to return to the previous volume.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Foreword
a call is accepted, the pop-up will show that the call is connected and the
cumulative call time will be shown.
1. When an incoming call is available, press the ENT key or the ANSWER soft
System
Sec 1
key to answer the call. Or, press the CLR key or the HANG UP soft key to not
answer the call and hang up.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 3-88 Incoming Call Pop-Up
2. After a called is accepted and connected, the connection time will be shown
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
on the pop-up. Press the ATT soft key to attenuate the call volume; pressing
it again will return to normal volume. Press the HANG UP soft key to end the
call. Press the VOL - or VOL + keys to adjust the call volume.
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
The Flight Plan Function shows the Current Flight Plan that is active in the
navigation source displayed on the CDI.
System
The Active Flight Plan box shows all of the legs of your flight plan with
the current leg indicated in magenta. Listed are each leg with the Desired
Track (DTK), Distance (DIS), and Estimated Time of Arrival (ETA) for the legs.
Sec 2
PFD
METARs are shown for waypoints in the flight plan. In the Minimums window,
the source and selected value are shown. For details about Minimum Descent
Altitude or Decision Height, refer to section 2.4.4. In the Active Leg Info box
Sec 3
MFD
in the lower part of the display, the Course with beginning and ending
waypoints, Active Leg En Route Safe Altitude (ESA), and Route ESA are shown.
METAR information is in section 4.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Graphic METARs
Current Leg
& Alerts
Annun.
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Baro
Minimums
Window
Appendix A
Active Leg
Window
Index
Foreword
Further information may be available for each waypoint as shown by the INFO
or WX soft keys. The WX soft key will only appear if a data link receiver is
installed and there is a Weather subscription.
1. Press the MFD knob and then use the large and small MFD knobs to highlight
System
Sec 1
waypoints in the flight plan.
2. Press the INFO soft key, if available, to view information about the highlighted
waypoint.
Sec 2
PFD
3. Press the WX soft key, if available, to view XM weather information about the
highlighted waypoint.
Sec 3
MFD
4. Press the small MFD knob to return to the Active Flight Plan page.
3.3.1.2 Active Flight Plan Options
Avoidance
The Active Flight Plan page provides information for the flight plan currently
Hazard
Sec 4
in use for navigation.
To change data fields on the Active Flight Plan Page:
Additional
Features
1. While viewing the Active Flight Plan Page of the FPL page group, press MENU
Sec 5
to display the Active Flight Plan Page Options window.
2. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight “Change Fields?” and then press ENT.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
3. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight the field you wish to change.
Appendix A
Index
Figure 3-92 Active Flight Plan Page Menu Change Fields Option Selection
4. Turn the small MFD knob to select the desired data item and press ENT.
5. Press the small MFD knob to remove the cursor.
Foreword
To restore factory default settings for data fields on the Active Flight Plan
Page:
1. While viewing the Active Flight Plan Page of the FPL page group, press MENU
System
Sec 1
Figure 3-93 Active Flight Plan Page Menu Option Selection to Restore Defaults
Avoidance
The Altitude Alerting function provides the pilot with visual and aural alerts
(if interfaced to an audio panel) when approaching the Selected Altitude. For
Additional
to refer to 2.4.4.
1. While viewing the Charts Page of the FPL page group, press the Menu key.
With the Set Minimums item highlighted, press ENT.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
2. With the Minimums Source highlighted, select the Altitude Minimums Alerter
source with small MFD knob.
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
3. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight the Altitude Minimums value. Turn the
large and small MFD knobs to change the Altitude Minimums value.
Appendix A
Index
In dual installations, the minimums alerting altitude value may be set from
either GDU 620 and will be synchronized on both units.
Foreword
NOTE: If you highlight the Minimums Altitude field on the FPL page and
press the CLR key, it will turn the minimums functionality off.
System
Sec 1
3.3.2 Waypoint Information Page
The Waypoint Information page provides details about a particular waypoint.
You can show a waypoint by selecting it by Ident, Facility Name, or by City.
Sec 2
PFD
The Map window shows the selected waypoint in the center of the map. The
Range keys zoom in and out on the map. The Info window at the bottom of
the display shows the Bearing and Distance from your present position to the
Sec 3
MFD
selected waypoint as well as its region and Lat/Lon coordinates.
Avoidance
Hazard
Facility Name
Sec 4
Facility Location
Additional
to Wpt from
Features
Sec 5
Present Position Lat/Lon
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Wpt Weather
Glossary
Sec 8
press the MFD knob and use the large and small MFD knobs to move the
cursor to select the identifier for the waypoint.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
OR
1. While viewing the Waypoint Information Info/Map page of the FPL page group,
Symbols
Sec 7
Foreword
OR
1. While viewing Navigation Map 1 or 2 of the MAP page group, press the MFD
System
knob and use the large and small MFD knobs to move the cursor to select the
Sec 1
identifier for the waypoint.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Selected
Hazard
Sec 4
Waypoint
Selection
Cursor
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Figure 3-99 Waypoint Selection - Nav Map Page Sec 6
2. Press the ENT key to select the waypoint.
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
the RWY/FREQ or APT DIR soft keys on the Waypoint Information page.
The current destination waypoint is the default item shown. You may select
a different Ident, Facility, or Location. In the Runway window, you may view
System
Sec 1
information about the runways. In the Frequency window, a scroll bar is shown
on the right side of the window when more frequencies are available.
Sec 2
PFD
Facility
Information
Window
Sec 3
MFD
Runway
Information
Window
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Airport
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Frequency
Window
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Ident/Facility/City Selection
The current destination Identifier, Facility Type with icon, Facility Name, and
Foreword
City (location) are shown in the top window of the Flight Plan mode Waypoint
Information page. The default is the Nearest airport if there is no active flight plan.
System
Sec 1
Access (Public/
Identifier Private and
Facility Name Symbol)
City
Sec 2
PFD
Figure 3-101 Flight Plan Ident/Facility/City Detail
1. While viewing the Waypoint Information page of the FPL page group, press
Sec 3
MFD
the RWY/FREQ, APT DIR, or WX soft keys to view information about the
waypoint.
Avoidance
Hazard
2. The current destination Ident, Facility, and City is shown, but may be changed
Sec 4
to find information about other choices. Press the small MFD knob to activate
the cursor. These fields may not be selected if the RWY, APT DIR, or WX pages
Additional
Features
are selected. If viewing those pages, press the soft key for that page again to
Sec 5
return to the Waypoint Information page.
3. Use the large MFD knob to highlight the field you wish to change and use the
& Alerts
Annun.
small MFD knob to change the value.
Sec 6
4. Press the ENT key to save the selected value or press the small MFD knob to
cancel editing.
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
runway number, runway length, surface type, and the frequency for Pilot-
Controlled Lighting (PCL).
More Runways
Runway Length
& Width Runway Surface
Lighting Information
Sec 2
PFD
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
1. While viewing the Waypoint Information page of the FPL page group, press the
Appendix A
RWY/FREQ soft key to view information about the waypoint and then press
the small MFD knob to activate the cursor.
2. Turn the small MFD knob to scroll through the available frequencies.
Index
Foreword
and the surrounding area. The RWY/FREQ and APT DIR soft keys are inactive
unless the selected waypoint is an airport or heliport.
System
NOTE: Airport Directory information comes from a database provided
Sec 1
by various 3rd parties. Refer to the Database information in the AUX
– SYSTEM STATUS page for details on the installed Airport Directory
database.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
1. While viewing the Waypoint Information page of the FPL page group, press the
APT DIR soft key to view more information about the waypoint.
Appendix A
and weather information is available for the selected waypoint. METAR and TAF
text are displayed on the Waypoint Weather Information Page. Pressing the
WX/NOTAM soft key will show the weather information page. Highlighting the
System
Sec 1
Product selection and turning the small MFD knob will display METAR data,
Terminal Area Forecast (TAF) information, and NOTAMs as they are available.
NOTAMs are also available when FIS-B is available.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
information.
Sec 8
3. Press the small MFD knob to return to the main Flight Plan page.
Appendix A
4 HAZARD AVOIDANCE
Foreword
The G500/G600 hazard avoidance features are designed to provide advisory
information of potential hazards to flight safety associated with weather, terrain,
and air traffic.
System
This section is divided into the following groups:
Sec 1
Terrain Avoidance
• Terrain Proximity
Sec 2
PFD
• TAWS-B (Optional)
• Terrain-SVT (Optional)
Traffic Avoidance
Sec 3
MFD
• Traffic Advisory System (Optional)
• Traffic Information Service (TIS) (Optional - GTX 33/330 Transponder
Avoidance
required)
Hazard
Sec 4
• ADS-B (Optional - ADS-B/FIS-B receiver required)
Weather
Additional
Features
Sec 5
• GDL 69/69A XM Satellite Weather (Optional)
• Weather Radar (Optional)
• GFDS Weather with the Iridium satellite system through GSR 56 (Optional)
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
• FIS-B Weather with ADS-B/FIS-B receiver (Optional)
• Stormscope (Optional)
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
NOTE: Terrain-SVT is not a fully functional TAWS and does not meet the
TAWS TSO-C151c.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
displayed along with a disclaimer. At the same time, the Terrain system self-test
begins. A failure message is issued if the terrain test fails (a message will not be
issued for Terrain Proximity).
System
Sec 1
Alert Source
Terrain MFD
PFD SVT Terrain/
Terrain/ Aural
Sec 2
Configuration Annunciator Obstacle
PFD
Obstacle Callouts
Text Shading
Alerts
Terrain Proximity - - - -
Sec 3
MFD
Terrain Proximity GNS/GTN GNS/GTN
- -
w/ GNS/GTN TAWS TAWS TAWS
Avoidance
Terrain Proximity 3rd-party
Hazard
Sec 4
- - -
w/3rd-party TAWS TAWS
Terrain-SVT G500/G600 G500/G600* G500/G600 G500/G600
Additional
Features
Terrain-SVT w/ G500/
Sec 5
GNS/GTN G500/G600/ GNS/GTN
GNS/GTN TAWS G600*/
TAWS** GTN*** TAWS**
GTN***
& Alerts
Annun.
Terrain-SVT 3rd-party
Sec 6
-
w/3rd-party TAWS TAWS
G500/G600
G500/G600 G500/G600* G500/G600 G500/G600
TAWS-B
Symbols
Sec 7
* SVT Terrain/Obstacle shading is only available when SVT is enabled and displayed.
** If the Garmin GPS/TAWS is not available, the G500/G600 Terrain-SVT will generate PFD annunciator
text and aural callouts. An advisory message will indicate when reversion to Terrain-SVT alerting has
Glossary
occurred.
Sec 8
*** GTN v5.10 and later with GDU v7.00 and later.
Table 4-1 G500/G600 Terrain Annunciations
GNS/GTN TAWS may be provided by a GNS 500WT-series or GTN-series
Appendix A
navigator with TAWS. The GNS/GTN TAWS must be interfaced to the G500/
G600 as GPS 1.
Each of the terrain awareness configurations are detailed in the following
Index
sub-sections.
standard feature of GDU 620 to increase situational awareness and help reduce
controlled flight into terrain (CFIT). Terrain may be displayed on the Map page
group Navigation Map and Terrain pages.
System
Sec 1
as database validity, hardware status, and GPS status. Should the system detect a
failure, a failure message will be displayed.
Index
Foreword
on the Navigation Map pages.
4.2.3.1 Terrain Proximity Page Display on the Terrain Page
1. Turn the large MFD knob to the MAP page group.
System
Sec 1
2. Turn the small MFD knob to the Terrain page.
3. Press the VIEW soft key to show the 360 and ARC soft keys.
Sec 2
PFD
Map Orientation Altitude
Information
North Indication
Sec 3
MFD
Range Rings
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Ownship Symbol
at Present Position
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Terrain and
Sec 6
Obstacle Altitude
Legend
Page Name
Symbols
Sec 7
Terrain Overlay
Sec 2
PFD
Terrain Legend
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
2. On Navigation Map page 1 or 2, press the MAP soft key to show the TERRAIN
Sec 6
soft key.
3. Press the TERRAIN soft key to overlay terrain on the Navigation Map.
Symbols
Sec 7
NOTE: Terrain Proximity and NEXRAD are mutually exclusive on the map
page.
Glossary
Sec 8
Press MENU and with the View Arc or View 360° selection highlighted press
ENT.
4-6 Garmin G500/G600 Pilot’s Guide 190-00601-02 Rev. J
TOC Cover
Foreword
Figure 4-3 Terrain Page Menu Viewing Selections
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 4-4 Terrain Page with 360° Rings Figure 4-5 Terrain Page with 120° Arc
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
4.2.3.4 Terrain Proximity Page Aviation Data
The Page Menu selections allow you to hide or show aviation data overlay on
the Terrain page.
Symbols
Sec 7
1. While viewing the Terrain page of the MAP page group, press MENU for Map
selections to hide or show aviation data overlay on the Terrain page.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Figure 4-7 Terrain Page with Aviation Data Displayed and 120° Arc View
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Foreword
potential impact points. Amber (caution) and red (warning) indicate terrain and
obstacle alerts relative to aircraft altitude. These colors adjust automatically as
the aircraft altitude changes.
System
Sec 1
Terrain/Obstacle Altitude Legend
The Terrain/Obstacle legend is displayed at the bottom right corner of the
Navigation Map. This option is available in the Map page group.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Figure 4-9 Terrain/Obstacle Altitude Legend
Hazard
Sec 4
Color Description
Red Terrain is at or within 100 ft below the current aircraft altitude
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Yellow Terrain is between 100 ft and 1,000 ft below the aircraft altitude
Black Terrain is more than 1,000 ft below the current aircraft altitude
& Alerts
Annun.
Table 4-2 Terrain Altitude Color Descriptions
Sec 6
Threat Location
Symbols
within 100 ft
100 ft Threshold below the aircraft
Unlighted Obstacle altitude (Red)
1000 ft
Glossary
Sec 8
Obstacle Icons
Foreword
NOTE: If an obstacle or terrain cell and the projected flight path of the
aircraft intersect, the display automatically zooms in to the closest threat
location on the TAWS page.
System
With the exception of power lines, any number of obstacles within close
Sec 1
proximity of each other may display as a group on the Navigation Map. The
MFD groups obstacles when they would otherwise overlap at the current zoom
scale. When a group is drawn, only the most immediate threat is depicted. An
Sec 2
PFD
asterisk at the upper left of an obstacle indicates that it is a group. The relative
altitude of the highest obstacle in the group determines the asterisk’s color.
To view obstacles individually, increase the current zoom scale.
Sec 3
MFD
Icon Description
Avoidance
Windmill
Windmill in Group
Symbols
Sec 7
Power Line
Glossary
Color Description
Appendix A
White
altitude
Table 4-4 Obstacle Altitude Color Descriptions
Foreword
TAWS (Terrain Awareness and Warning System) is an optional feature to
increase situational awareness and aid in reducing controlled flight into terrain
(CFIT). TAWS provides visual and aural annunciations when terrain and
System
Sec 1
obstacles are within the given altitude threshold from the aircraft.
TAWS satisfies TSO-C151c Class B requirements for certification. Class B
TAWS is required for all Part 91 turbine aircraft operations with six or more
Sec 2
PFD
passenger seats and for Part 135 turbine aircraft operations with six to nine
passenger seats (FAR Parts 91.223, 135.154).
Sec 3
MFD
4.3.1 TAWS-B Requirements
TAWS requires the following to operate properly:
Avoidance
• A valid terrain/obstacle
Hazard
Sec 4
• A valid 3-D GPS position solution
Additional
Features
Sec 5
WARNING: The data contained in the TAWS databases comes from
government agencies. Garmin accurately processes and cross-validates the
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
data but cannot guarantee the accuracy and completeness of the data.
TAWS displays terrain and obstructions relative to the altitude of the aircraft.
Refer to AFM for procedures for TAWS alerts.
Symbols
Sec 7
displayed along with a disclaimer to the pilot. At the same time, TAWS self-test
begins. One of the following aural messages is generated:
• “TAWS System Test OK”
System
Sec 1
TAWS uses information provided from the GPS receiver to provide a horizontal
position and altitude. GPS altitude is derived from satellite measurements.
GPS altitude is converted to a Mean Sea Level (MSL)-based altitude (GPS-MSL
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
MSL altitude does not require local altimeter settings to determine MSL altitude.
Sec 5
Therefore, GPS altitude provides a highly accurate and reliable MSL altitude
source to calculate terrain and obstacle alerts.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
The terrain and obstacle databases used by TAWS are referenced to Mean
Sea Level. Using the GPS position and GPS-MSL altitude, TAWS displays a 2-D
(or 3-D with SVT) picture of the surrounding terrain and obstacles relative to
Symbols
the position and altitude of the aircraft. Furthermore, the GPS position and
Sec 7
GPS-MSL altitude are used to calculate and “predict” the aircraft’s flight path
in relation to the surrounding terrain and obstacles. In this manner, TAWS can
provide advanced alerts of predicted dangerous terrain conditions.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
TAWS Page is specialized to show terrain, obstacle, and Threat Area Indication
data in relation to the aircraft’s current altitude, without clutter from the
basemap. Aviation data (airports, VORs, and other NAVAIDs) can be displayed
System
Sec 1
for reference. The display automatically zooms in to the closest potential point
of impact on the TAWS Page.
Aircraft orientation on this map is always heading up unless there is no valid
Sec 2
PFD
heading. If orientation is not heading up, it will be track up. Two views are
available relative to the position of the aircraft: the 360° default display and the
radar-like ARC (120°) display. Map range is adjustable with the RNG keys from
Sec 3
MFD
1 to 200 NM, as indicated by the map range rings (or arcs).
Displaying TAWS Information
1) In MAP page group, turn the small MFD knob to reach the TAWS Page.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
2) Press the RNG keys to display a larger or smaller area.
Map Orientation Altitude
Additional
Features
North Indication Information
Sec 5
Range Rings
Sec 6
and 1,000 ft Below the
Aircraft Altitude)
Ownship Symbol
Red Terrain (Warning at Present Position
- Terrain Above or
Symbols
Sec 7
Obstacle Altitude
Sec 8
360° 120°
Range Ring Arc
Selection Selection
Figure 4-11 360˚ View on the TAWS Page
Index
2. Press VIEW and then the 360 or ARC soft key to select the desired view.
OR
1. While viewing the TAWS page, press the MENU key.
System
Sec 1
2. Turn the large or small MFD knob to highlight “View Arc” or “View 360°” and
then press ENT.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
2. Press the MENU key. Turn the large or small MFD knob to highlight “Show
Aviation Data” or “Hide Aviation Data” and then press ENT.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
2. Press the MENU key and then turn the large or small MFD knob to highlight
“Test TAWS.”
Index
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Figure 4-14 TAWS Page Menu
3. Press the ENT key to confirm the selection.
Sec 2
PFD
One of the following aural messages is generated:
• “TAWS System Test OK”
• “TAWS System Failure”
Sec 3
MFD
TAWS TEST is annunciated in yellow on the TAWS page and in white on the
PFD.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
When an alert is issued, annunciations appear on the PFD and MFD (TAWS
map page only). The TAWS Alert Annunciation is shown to the upper left of
Sec 2
the Altimeter on the PFD and below the Terrain Legend on the MFD. If the
PFD
TAWS page is not displayed at the time, a pop-up alert appears on the MFD on
the page being viewed.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
TAWS Alert
Pop-Up
Symbols
Sec 7
OR
• Press the ENT key (accesses the TAWS Page)
If the pilot takes no action, the pop-up will be removed when the alert is no
Index
longer active.
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Figure 4-17 TAWS Alert Annunciations (Pull Up)
Additional
Features
Sec 5
4.3.5.1 TAWS-B Alerting Colors and Symbology
Color and symbols are also associated with TAWS alerts. The three TAWS
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
alert levels and their associated text coloring as well as any associated symbology
are shown in the following table.
Alert Level Annunciator Text Threat Area Example Visual Annunciation
Symbols
Sec 7
Indication Symbol
Warning White text on red
background
Glossary
Sec 8
PFD/MFD Alert
Alert Type Aural Message
Annunciation
Foreword
Pull Up”*
PFD
(ROC-W, IOI-W)
“Obstacle, Obstacle; Pull Up, Pull Up”
FLTA Wire Warning “Wire Ahead, Pull Up; Wire Ahead, Pull Up”*
Sec 3
MFD
Caution (EDR-C)
Negative Climb Rate “Don’t Sink”*
Caution (NCR-C) “Too Low, Terrain”
Glossary
Sec 8
* Alerts with multiple messages are configurable at installation and are installation-dependent. Alerts for
the default configuration are indicated with asterisks.
Appendix A
Foreword
notification when the aircraft is determined to be descending upon terrain at an
excessive rate. The parameters for the alert as defined by TSO-C151c are shown
below.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Figure 4-18 Excessive Descent Rate Alert Criteria
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Clearance (ROC) alerts are issued when the aircraft flight path is above terrain,
yet is projected to come within the minimum clearance values in the FLTA Alert
Minimum Terrain and Obstacle Clearance Values table. When an RTC alert and/
System
Sec 1
the aircraft’s projected path. ITI and IOI alerts are accompanied by a potential
impact point displayed on the TAWS Page. The alert is annunciated when the
projected vertical flight path is calculated to come within minimum clearance
Sec 3
MFD
During final approach, FLTA alerts are automatically inhibited when the
aircraft is below 200 feet AGL while within 0.5 NM of the approach runway or
below 125 feet AGL while within 1.0 NM of the runway threshold.
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
aircraft is significantly below the normal approach path to a runway.
PDA alerting begins when the aircraft is within 15 NM of the destination
airport and ends when the aircraft is either 0.5 NM from the runway threshold
System
Sec 1
or is at an altitude of 125 feet AGL while within 1.0 NM of the threshold. During
the final descent, algorithms set a threshold for alerting based on speed, distance,
and other parameters.
Sec 2
PFD
700
Height Above Terrain (Feet)
600
500
Sec 3
MFD
400
300
Avoidance
Hazard
PDA Alerting Area
Sec 4
200
100
Runway 1
Additional
2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
Features
Threshold
Sec 5
Distance From Destination Airport (nm)
visual alerts. Pilots should use discretion when inhibiting TAWS and always
remember to enable the system when appropriate. Only the PDA and FLTA
alerts are disabled in the inhibit mode.
System
Sec 1
Figure 4-20 TAWS Alerting Disabled (TAWS Inhibited) Annunciation (PFD & MFD)
1. In MAP page group, turn the small MFD knob to reach the TAWS Page.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
2. Press the INHIBIT soft key to inhibit or enable TAWS (choice dependent on
current state).
OR
Additional
Features
Sec 5
TAWS” (choice dependent on current state) and press the ENT key.
Sec 6
alert that the aircraft is 500 feet above terrain. When the aircraft descends within
500 feet of terrain, the aural message “Five-hundred” is generated. There are no
display annunciations or pop-up alerts that accompany the aural message.
Glossary
Sec 8
Foreword
“Altitude Loss After Take-Off”) provides alerts when the system determines the
aircraft is losing altitude (closing upon terrain) after takeoff. The aural message
“Don’t Sink” is given for NCR alerts, accompanied by an annunciation and a
System
Sec 1
pop-up terrain alert on the display. NCR alerting is only active when departing
from an airport and when the following conditions are met:
• Height above the terrain is less than 700 feet
Sec 2
PFD
• Distance from the departure airport is 2 NM or less
• Heading change from the departure heading is less than 110º
Sec 3
The NCR alerting parameters as defined by TSO-C151c are shown below.
MFD
Height Above Terrain (Feet)
1000
Avoidance
Hazard
800
Sec 4
600
400
“DON’T SINK”
Additional
Features
Sec 5
200
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Height Above Terrain (Feet)
1000
900
800
700
Symbols
Sec 7
600
500
400
300 “DON’T SINK”
200
Glossary
Sec 8
100
“TAWS Not Available” is generated. When the GPS signal is re-established and
the aircraft is within the database coverage area, the aural message “TAWS
Available” is generated.
Sec 2
PFD
available, the aural message “TAWS System Failure” is generated along with a
‘TAWS FAIL’ annunciation.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
annunciations. The system test can also be manually initiated. An aural alert is
Features
Sec 5
issued at test completion. TAWS System Testing is disabled when ground speed
exceeds 30 knots.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
PFD/MFD Alert
Alert Type Aural Message
Annunciation
TAWS Available None “TAWS Available”
Symbols
Sec 7
Foreword
GPS 1, text alerts generated by the external TAWS unit will be displayed on
the PFD. Refer to the GNS 500WT-series or GTN-series Pilot’s Guides and/
or Addendums for more information regarding these TAWS alerts. Text alerts
System
Sec 1
received from the GNS/GTN TAWS unit will be displayed to the left and aligned
with the top of the Altitude Tape on the PFD. A new annunciation will flash for
approximately five seconds.
• TAWS annunciations can only be received from the #1 GPS unit.
Sec 2
PFD
• If the Garmin GPS/TAWS is not available and Terrain-SVT is enabled, the
G500/G600 Terrain-SVT will generate PFD text alerts and aural callouts.
Sec 3
An advisory message will indicate when reversion to Terrain-SVT alerting
MFD
has occurred.
• For External TAWS (HSDB), terrain impact points on the MFD are
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
generated from the data crossfilled from the GTN.
Additional
Features
Figure 4-22 TAWS Annunciations from a GNS/GTN TAWS
Sec 5
Terrain PFD/MFD Visual MFD Pop-up Aural
Configurations Annunciations Alert Alerting
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
GTN w/ External When configured for External None None
TAWS Unit TAWS (HSDB), the GDU will not
Installed (HSDB) generate any alerts; all alerts are
crossfilled from the GTN.
Symbols
Sec 7
G500/G600.
Table 4-9 G500/G600 TAWS Annunciations
Avoidance
4.5 Terrain-SVT
Hazard
Sec 4
Garmin Terrain-SVT refers to a subset of Class B TAWS that meets the terrain
alerting requirements outlined in Section 7.b of AC 23-26. Terrain-SVT is a
Additional
Features
subset of Class B TAWS that provides a Class B TAWS FLTA functionality with
Sec 5
visual alerting and aural alerting. Terrain-SVT is provided with Synthetic Vision
Technology (SVT) functionality and not marketed separately.
& Alerts
Annun.
Alerting
• Imminent Terrain Impact (ITI) / Imminent Obstacle Impact (IOI)
Alerting
Glossary
Sec 8
Garmin Terrain-SVT is required for those SVT installations that do not have
TAWS-A or TAWS-B enabled.
Index
Foreword
360/Arc soft keys or from the Page Menu.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Figure 4-23 Terrain-SVT 360 and Arc Views
Features
Sec 5
1. Press VIEW and then the 360 or Arc soft key.
OR
& Alerts
2. Press MENU and the with the "View Arc" or "View 360°" selection highlighted
Annun.
Sec 6
press ENT. Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
selections allow you to hide or show aviation data overlay on the Terrain or the
Map Setup options for the Navigation Map pages.
1. While viewing the Terrain page of the MAP page group, press MENU for Map
System
Sec 1
selections to hide or show aviation data overlay on the Terrain or the Map
Setup options for the Navigation Map pages.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Terrain-SVT has an inhibit mode that deactivates the FLTA aural and visual
Sec 5
alerts. Pilots should use discretion when inhibiting Terrain-SVT and always
remember to enable the system when appropriate.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Figure 4-26 Terrain-SVT Alerting Disabled (Alerts Inhibited) Annunciation (PFD & MFD)
1. In MAP page group, turn the small MFD knob to reach the Terrain SVT Page.
Glossary
Sec 8
2. Press the INHIBIT soft key to inhibit or enable Terrain SVT (choice dependent
on current state).
Appendix A
OR
1. Press the MENU key.
2. Use the large or small MFD knob to highlight “Inhibit Terrain” or “Enable
Index
Terrain” (choice dependent on current state) and press the ENT key.
Foreword
level, or both. When an alert is issued, visual annunciations are displayed and
aural alerts are simultaneously issued.
When an alert is issued, annunciations appear on the PFD and MFD (Terrain-
System
Sec 1
SVT page only). The TAWS/Terrain Alert Annunciation is shown to the upper
left of the Altimeter on the PFD and below the Terrain Legend on the MFD. If
the Terrain-SVT page is not displayed at the time, a pop-up alert appears on the
Sec 2
PFD
MFD.
To acknowledge the pop-up alert:
Press the CLR key (returns to the currently viewed page)
Sec 3
MFD
OR
Press the ENT key (accesses the Terrain-SVT Page)
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
(RTC-C, ITI-C)
FLTA Terrain Caution
“Caution, Wire, Wire”
(RLC-C, ILI-C)
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
(RLC-W, ILI-W)
FLTA Obstacle Caution
“Caution, Obstacle, Obstacle”
(ROC-C, IOI-C)
Glossary
Sec 8
Foreword
The Traffic function requires the installation of a compatible traffic device
and will then provide a separate traffic page in the Map page group as well as the
overlay of traffic on the Map Navigation pages. TIS and TAS cannot be displayed
at the same time. If the aircraft has a TAS unit installed, the GDU 620 will be
System
Sec 1
configured for TAS. If no TAS unit is installed and a GTX Mode-S transponder
is installed then the GDU 620 will be configured for TIS. A pilot can tell which
data is being displayed by the label in the top left corner (TAS/TCAS: OPER
Sec 2
PFD
for TAS/TCAS data and TIS: OPER for TIS data). TIS data comes from a GTX
transponder. Coverage is limited to specific areas as shown in the Airmen’s
Information Manual (AIM). TAS data comes from a TAS unit such as a Garmin
Sec 3
MFD
GTS 800 or 820, Skywatch 497, KTA 810, or other unit. Coverage follows the
aircraft. In the Navigation Map page setup you can select the maximum range at
which traffic symbols are shown. Once outside of the selected range, traffic will
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
be decluttered. The Traffic soft key will still be available. The Garmin GDL 88
can provide TIS-B and ADS-B information. The Garmin GTS ADS-B products
can also provide ADS-B information.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
4.6.1 TAS/TCAS 1 Traffic (Optional)
TAS refers to an active Traffic Advisory System that may be optionally
displayed on the PFD and/or MFD. The TAS is installed separately from the
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
G500/G600 system. There are variations in performance and control among
the various G500/G600-compatible TAS systems. Refer to the appropriate TAS
documentation for detailed information on the operation of the TAS system.
Symbols
Sec 7
This section describes the display and control functions available on the
G500/G600 system.
Glossary
Traffic Advisory Systems (TAS) and TIS. Aircraft without altitude reporting
capability are shown without altitude separation data or climb descent
indication.
to the aircraft’s current position and altitude. Traffic page orientation is always
heading up. The traffic mode and altitude filter mode are annunciated in the
upper left corner.
System
Sec 1
Operating Mode
Sec 2
PFD
Range Ring
Traffic Advisory,
200 ft Above and
Sec 3
MFD
Proximity Descending
Advisory, Aircraft
is 500 ft Above Ownship Symbol
and Descending
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Non-Threat
Traffic, Non-Threat Traffic,
2000 ft Above 2000 ft Below and
and Climbing Climbing
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
1. While viewing the Traffic Page of the MAP page group, select the OPERATE soft
key to select Operating Mode.
Appendix A
2. To switch to Standby Mode from the Traffic Page, select the STANDBY soft key.
NOTE: Not all TAS systems can be controlled from the G500/G600. The
Operate/Standby soft keys may not be displayed. An alert will be generated
when Standby is selected and the aircraft is in the air.
Index
Foreword
the installed equipment.
4.6.1.4 Altitude Display
Changing the altitude display mode
System
Sec 1
1. Press the ALT MODE soft key to change the altitude filter.
2. Select the desired altitude filter by pressing the BELOW, NORMAL,
Sec 2
PFD
ABOVE, or UNRSTD (unrestricted) soft keys. The selection is displayed in the
Altitude mode field.
Altitude Mode Displayed Traffic Range (ft)
Sec 3
MFD
Below -9,900 to 2,700
Normal -2,700 to 2,700
Avoidance
Above -2,700 to 9,900
Hazard
Sec 4
Unrestricted All Traffic Shown (-9,900 to 9,900)
Table 4-12 Displayed Traffic Range
Additional
Features
Sec 5
NOTE: Traffic Advisories (TAs) are always displayed, regardless of altitude
mode.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Other Traffic
System
Sec 1
to the traffic system documentation for information regarding the criteria used
to determine target type.
Additional
aircraft. Closing rate, distance, and vertical separation meet TA criteria for the
specific traffic system. A Traffic Advisory that is beyond the selected display
range is indicated by a half TA symbol at the edge of the screen at the relative
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Foreword
NOTE: Refer to the equipment documentation for information on the
self-test and operating modes.
The traffic mode is indicated in the upper left corner of the Traffic Map
System
Page.
Sec 1
Traffic Mode Annunciation
Mode
Sec 2
(Traffic Map Page)
PFD
TEST
TAS Self-test Initiated
(also shown in white in center of page)
Sec 3
MFD
TAS Operating OPERATING
Avoidance
Hazard
STANDBY
Sec 4
TAS Standby
(also shown in white in center of page)
Table 4-14 TAS Modes
Additional
Features
Sec 5
If the unit fails, an annunciation as to the cause of the failure is shown in the
center of the Traffic Map Page.
& Alerts
Annun.
Traffic Map Page
Sec 6
Description
Annunciation
NO DATA Data is not being received from the TAS unit.
Symbols
Sec 7
Data is being received from the TAS unit, but the unit is
DATA FAILED
self-reporting a failure.
FAILED Incorrect data format received from the TAS unit.
Appendix A
For TAS traffic, TEST MODE can be initiated from the Page Menu (press the
MENU key) when the traffic device is in Standby mode.
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
and a traffic alert becomes active, the Traffic pop-up will be displayed.
NOTE: The traffic pop-up will not appear when your aircraft is on the
ground.
System
Sec 1
Press ENT to go directly to the Traffic page.
OR
Sec 2
PFD
Press CLR to return to the previously viewed page.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Traffic Pop-Up
Symbols
Sec 7
NOTE: TIS is available only when the aircraft is within the service volume of
a TIS-capable terminal radar site. Aircraft without an operating transponder
are invisible to both Traffic Advisory Systems (TAS) and TIS. Aircraft without
altitude reporting capability are shown without altitude separation data
Sec 2
PFD
The type of traffic systems that is installed is determined by the traffic page
Hazard
Sec 4
link. TIS receives traffic information from ground stations, and is updated every
Annun.
Sec 6
five seconds. The GDU 620 displays up to eight traffic targets within a 7.5 NM
radius, from 3,000 feet below to 3,500 feet above the requesting aircraft. Traffic
is displayed according to TCAS symbology using three different symbols.
Symbols
Sec 7
relation to the aircraft’s current position and altitude, without clutter from the
Sec 8
The traffic mode is annunciated in the upper left corner of the Traffic Map
Page. When the aircraft is on the ground, TIS automatically enters Standby
Mode. Once the aircraft is airborne, TIS switches from Standby to Operating
Mode and the GDU 620 begins to display traffic information.
Index
Foreword
2. Turn the small MFD knob to select the Traffic Map Page.
3. Confirm TIS is in Operating Mode:
System
Sec 1
Select the OPERATE soft key to begin displaying traffic.
OR
1. Press the MENU key.
Sec 2
PFD
2. Select Operate Mode (shown if TIS is in Standby Mode) and then press the ENT
key.
Sec 3
MFD
Operating
Mode
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Traffic Advisory,
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Aircraft is 1200 feet
above, climbing,
and moving in the
direction of the line
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Other Traffic,
Aircraft is 3000 feet
above, climbing and
Symbols
Sec 7
Non-Threat Traffic
System
Sec 1
symbol at the edge of the screen at the relative bearing of the intruder.
TIS also provides a vector line showing the direction in which the traffic
is moving, to the nearest 45º. Traffic information for which TIS is unable to
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
The altitude difference between the requesting aircraft and other intruder
aircraft is displayed above/below the traffic symbol in hundreds of feet. If the
other aircraft is above the requesting aircraft, the altitude separation appears
Glossary
Sec 8
above the traffic symbol; if below, the altitude separation appears below. Altitude
trend is displayed as an up/down arrow (for speeds greater than 500 fpm in
either direction) to the right of the target symbol. Traffic symbols for aircraft
Appendix A
Foreword
NOTE: This section on TIS Limitations is not comprehensive. Garmin
recommends the user review the TIS Limitations section of the Aeronautical
Information Manual, Section 1-3-5.
System
TIS is NOT intended to be used as a collision avoidance system and does not
Sec 1
relieve the pilot of responsibility to “see and avoid” other aircraft. TIS should not
be used for avoidance maneuvers during IMC or other times when there is no
visual contact with the intruder aircraft. TIS is intended only to assist in visual
Sec 2
PFD
acquisition of other aircraft in VMC. No recommended avoidance maneuvers
are provided for, nor authorized, as a direct result of a TIS intruder display or
TIS advisory.
Sec 3
MFD
While TIS is a useful aid to visual traffic avoidance, it has some system
limitations that must be fully understood to ensure proper use. Many of these
Avoidance
limitations are inherent in secondary radar surveillance. In other words, the
Hazard
Sec 4
information provided by TIS will be no better than that provided to ATC. TIS
will only display aircraft with operating transponders installed.
Additional
TIS relies on surveillance of the Mode S radar, which is a “secondary
Features
Sec 5
surveillance” radar similar to the ATCRBS. TIS operation may be intermittent
during turns or other maneuvering. TIS is dependent on two-way, “line-of-
sight” communication between the aircraft and the Mode S radar. Whenever the
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
structure of the client aircraft comes between the transponder antenna (usually
located on the underside of the aircraft) and the ground-based radar antenna,
the signal may be temporarily interrupted. Other limitations and anomalies
Symbols
Sec 7
NOTE: TIS will be unavailable at low altitudes in many areas of the U.S.,
Sec 3
MFD
TIS information is collected one radar scan prior to the scan during which
the uplink occurs. Therefore, the surveillance information is approximately
five seconds old. In order to present the intruders in a “real time” position,
Additional
Features
Sec 5
the TIS ground station uses a “predictive algorithm” in its tracking software.
This algorithm uses track history data to extrapolate intruders to their expected
positions consistent with the time of display in the cockpit. Occasionally, aircraft
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
maneuvering will cause this algorithm to induce errors in the display. These
errors primarily affect relative bearing information and traffic target track vector
(it will lag); intruder distance and altitude will remain relatively accurate and
Symbols
may be used to assist in “see and avoid.” Some of the more common examples
Sec 7
course at a shallow angle (either overtaking or head on) and either aircraft
abruptly changes course within 0.25 NM, TIS may display the intruder on
the opposite side of the client than it actually is.
Index
Foreword
increases from one scan to the next, the following occur:
• A single “Traffic” voice alert is generated.
System
• A TRAFFIC Annunciation appears to the top left of the Attitude Indicator
Sec 1
on the PFD, flashing for 5 seconds and remaining displayed until no TAs are
detected in the area.
To reduce the number of nuisance alerts due to proximate aircraft,
Sec 2
PFD
the “Traffic” voice alert is generated only when the number of TAs
increases. For example, when the first TA is displayed, a voice and visual
annunciation are generated. As long as a single TA remains on the display,
Sec 3
MFD
no additional voice alerts are generated. If a second TA appears on the
display or if the number of TAs initially decreases and then subsequently
increases, another voice alert is generated.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
A “Traffic Not Available” (TNA) voice alert is generated when the TIS service
becomes unavailable or is out of range.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Traffic may not be displayed in the radar coverage area due to the following:
• Radar site TIS Mode S sensor is not operational or is out of service.
• Traffic or requesting aircraft is beyond the maximum range of the TIS-
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
capable Mode S radar site.
• Traffic or requesting aircraft is above the radar site in the cone of silence and
out of range of an adjacent site.
Symbols
Sec 7
directions.
• Traffic does not have an operating transponder.
Appendix A
Index
TIS passes the test, TIS enters Standby Mode on the ground or Operating
Mode in the air. If TIS fails the power up test, an annunciation is shown
in the center of the Traffic Map Page.
System
Sec 1
Page. When the aircraft is on the ground, TIS automatically enters Standby
Sec 5
Mode. If traffic is selected for display on another map while Standby Mode is
selected, the traffic display enabled icon is crossed out (also the case when TIS
has failed). Once the aircraft is airborne, TIS switches to Operating Mode and
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
traffic information is displayed. The mode can be changed manually using soft
keys or the page menu.
Symbols
Sec 7
STANDBY
TIS Standby (Also shown in white in center of
Appendix A
page)
Foreword
knob to the Traffic Map Page.
2. Select the STANDBY or OPERATE soft key to switch between modes. The mode
is displayed in the upper left corner of the Traffic Map Page.
System
Sec 1
OR
1. Press the MENU key.
Sec 2
PFD
2. Select Operate mode or Standby mode whether airborne or on the ground.
3. Press the ENT key.
Sec 3
MFD
NOTE: An alert will be generated when Standby is selected and the
aircraft is in the air.
Avoidance
Hazard
The annunciations indicate the status of traffic information appear in a banner
Sec 4
at the lower left corner of maps on which traffic can be displayed.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Traffic Status
Banner Description
Foreword
Annunciation
A Traffic Advisory is outside the selected display range.
TA OFF SCALE* Annunciation is removed when traffic comes within the
System
Sec 1
descending).
System cannot determine bearing of Traffic Advisory.
Annunciation indicates distance in NM, altitude separation
Sec 3
MFD
TA/ X.XNM/± XX↕ in hundreds of feet, and altitude trend arrow (climbing/
** descending). The system distance units are set to Metric or
Avoidance
Imperial and are shown as such in all other cases except for
Hazard
Sec 4
not displayed.
TRFC FAIL Traffic data has failed.
Appendix A
Foreword
aircraft equipped with ADS-B out capability.
System
Sec 1
Absolute Below
Relative Normal
Off Above
Sec 2
PFD
Duration Unrestricted
30 Sec Back
1 Min
2 Min
Sec 3
MFD
5 Min
Back
Avoidance
Back
Hazard
Sec 4
Figure 4-31 ADS-B Traffic Page Functional Diagram
When in Standby mode, pressing the MENU key will show the Page menu
Additional
Features
Sec 5
where the traffic LRU can be placed into TEST mode.
4.6.3.1 Target Selection
Traffic targets displayed on the dedicated traffic page may be selected in order
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
to obtain additional information about a traffic target.
1. Press the small MFD knob to start target selection.
Symbols
ADS-B and
TCAS Status and
Altitude Filter Selected
Foreword
Traffic Motion
Basic Directional Vector
Traffic, 4000 ft
Below and
Ownship
Sec 2
PFD
Climbing
Icon
Range Rings
Sec 3
MFD
Turn Cursor
Avoidance
Selected Vector
Hazard
Sec 4
NOTE: Traffic targets within 1200 ft vertical separation and 6NM from
the ownship are depicted as proximate targets.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbol Description
Basic Non-Directional Traffic
Symbols
Sec 7
Symbol Description
Off-Scale Non-Directional Alerted Traffic
Foreword
Directional Alerted Traffic
System
Off-Scale Directional Alerted Traffic
Sec 1
Non-Directional Surface Vehicle
Sec 2
PFD
Directional Surface Vehicle
Sec 3
MFD
NOTE: Color of basic and proximate traffic is dependent on airborne/on-ground
status of target (target is brown when on the ground, see the surface vehicles).
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
4.6.3.2 Status
ADS-B Status
Additional
ADS-B Status displays the current status of traffic application: Off, Surface,
Features
Sec 5
Airborne, N/A, Fail, or Test.
TCAS Status
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
If a TCAS system is integrated with the ADS-B system then this shows the
current status of the TCAS system. When the ADS-B system is integrated with a
TCAS system, the controls are provided on the installed navigator.
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
traffic targets depict the target reported track and speed over the ground. When
Relative Motion Vectors are selected, the vectors extending from the traffic targets
display how the traffic target is moving relative to your aircraft. These vectors are
System
calculated using the traffic targets track and ground speed and your aircraft’s track
Sec 1
and ground speed. These two values are combined to depict where the traffic target
is moving with respect to your aircraft and indicates where the traffic target will be,
relative to your aircraft, at the time specified by the length of the vector.
Sec 2
PFD
NOTE: Absolute motion vectors match the color of the intruder (white or
yellow). Relative motion vectors are green except for Traffic Advisories whose
Relative Motion vectors are yellow. The annunciation on the bottom of the
Sec 3
MFD
dedicated traffic page indicates which vector type is selected and their length.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Figure 4-34 Relative Motion (Green Vectors)
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Vector Duration
The Vector Duration selection sets the time that the vector will show the
calculated distance and direction of the traffic target. A longer duration will
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
result in a longer vector. Press the smart key for the desired duration.
Altitude Filter
The Altitude Filter limits the traffic displayed to the Below, Normal, Above or
Symbols
Sec 7
Unrestricted altitude block as listed in the “Displayed Traffic Range” table. The
filter altitudes are relative to ownship altitude. Press the Alt Mode smart key to
display the altitude smart keys. Press the smart key to select the altitude filter
Glossary
Sec 8
value.
The primary map for viewing XM WX Satellite Weather data are the Weather
Data Link Pages in the Map Page Group. These are the only GDU 620 map
displays capable of all available XM WX Satellite weather products. The XM
WW Satellite Weather pages may be oriented to either Track Up or North Up.
System
Sec 1
Navigation Map Page, the age of the data is displayed on the screen. The age of
the product is based on the time difference between when the data was assembled
on the ground and the current GPS time. Weather products are refreshed at
Sec 3
MFD
the display. This ensures that the displayed data is consistent with what is
currently being broadcast by XM WX Satellite Radio services. If more than half
of the expiration time has elapsed from the time the data is received, the color of
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
Data Link Map pages are customized by selecting options from the Page Menu.
The Page Menu options include choices for Weather Setup and displaying the
Weather Legends. The Weather Setup choice covers selections for adjusting the
System
Sec 1
viewing ranges of the weather products.
1. While viewing a WX Data Link Map page of the WX page group, press the
MENU key to display the Page Menu Options. The cursor flashes on the
Sec 2
PFD
“Weather Setup” option. Press ENT.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Figure 4-35 Weather Page Menu Options
Hazard
Sec 4
2. Turn the Large or Small MFD knob to select Weather Setup (1/2) or Weather
Setup (2/2) and press ENT.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Figure 4-36 Weather Setup Group Selection
3. With the Data Link Setup Menu displayed, turn the Large MFD knob to
Symbols
highlight the desired item and then turn the small MFD knob to select the
Sec 7
desired weather feature value. Where a value (such as 100 NM) is selected,
weather data will be shown at map ranges of the selected value (100 NM)
and lower.
Glossary
Sec 8
knob to cancel and return to the XM WX Satellite Weather Data Link Map Page.
Index
Foreword
shown in the following tables. The broadcast rate represents the interval at which
XM WX Satellite Radio broadcasts new signals that may or may not contain new
weather data. It does not represent the rate at which weather data is updated or new
System
content is received by the Data Link Receiver. Weather data is updated at intervals
Sec 1
that are defined and controlled by XM WX Satellite Radio and its data vendors.
The product label in the legend will turn yellow at half the expiration time
and gray when expired. Expired products will not be shown on the display.
Sec 2
PFD
WARNING: Do not use data link weather information for maneuvering in,
near, or around areas of hazardous weather. Information contained within
Sec 3
MFD
data link weather products may not accurately depict current weather
conditions.
Avoidance
WARNING: Do not use the indicated data link weather product age to
Hazard
Sec 4
determine the age of the weather information shown by the data link
weather product. Due to time delays inherent in gathering and processing
weather data for data link transmission, the weather information shown by
Additional
Features
the data link weather product may be significantly older than the indicated
Sec 5
weather product age.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
SIGMETs / AIRMETs 60
METARs 90
City Forecast 90
Sec 3
MFD
Surface Analysis 60
Freezing Levels 120
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Winds Aloft 90
County Warnings 60
PIREPS 90
Additional
Features
Sec 5
TFRs 60
AIREPS 90
Icing 90
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Turbulence 180
Cyclone Warnings 60
Symbols
by XM Weather Service.
included on the weather map. The valid time for these products is
displayed on the weather map in place of the generation time.
The valid time indication for XM Freezing Level, Winds Aloft and Canada
Winds Aloft is not displayed. Instead, the generation time for these is
Index
displayed.
Symbol Description
Flood
Foreword
Severe Thunderstorm
System
Tornado
Sec 1
Sunny
Sec 2
PFD
Part Sun
Cloudy
Sec 3
Rainy
MFD
T-Storm
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Snow
Windy
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Foggy
Haze
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
High/Low Temp
Table 4-25 Weather Symbols
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
products. Pressing the LEGEND soft key again, the MFD knob, the ENT, or
CLR keys will remove the legend.
1. A full page legend can be selected by selecting the Weather Legend option in
the XM Weather Map Menu or pressing the LEGEND soft key on the Weather
System
Sec 1
Map Page. The legend displayed will match the selected weather products. Turn
the large or small MFD knobs to scroll through the legend, if necessary.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Figure 4-37 Weather Legends
Avoidance
Hazard
2. An abbreviated legend may be displayed on the upper right side of a WX Data
Sec 4
Link Map page for the applicable weather products when selected in the Page
Menu options for Weather.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
4.7.5 XM NEXRAD
WSR-88D, or NEXRAD (NEXt-generation RADar), is a network of 158 high-
resolution Doppler radar systems that are operated by the National Weather
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Service (NWS). NEXRAD data provides centralized meteorological information
for the continental United States and selected overseas locations. The maximum
range of a single NEXRAD radar site is 250 NM. The NEXRAD network provides
Symbols
Sec 7
the current radar synopsis. Due to the inherent delays and the relative age of
the data, it should be used for long-range planning purposes only. Never use
Appendix A
NEXRAD data or any radar data to penetrate hazardous weather. Instead, use it
in an early-warning capacity of pre-departure and en route evaluation.
Index
Composite data from all the NEXRAD radar sites in the United States is shown.
This data is composed of the maximum reflectivity from the individual radar
sweeps. The display of the information is color-coded to indicate the weather
Additional
Features
severity level. All weather product legends can be viewed on the Weather Data
Sec 5
Link Page. For the NEXRAD legend, select the LEGEND soft key when NEXRAD
is selected for display.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
information is not currently available or is not being collected are indicated in
grayish-purple.
4.7.5.1 Reflectivity
System
Sec 1
Reflectivity is the amount of transmitted power returned to the radar receiver.
Colors on the NEXRAD display directly correlate to the level of detected
reflectivity. Reflectivity as it relates to hazardous weather can be very complex.
Sec 2
PFD
The role of radar is essentially to detect moisture in the atmosphere. Simply
put, certain types of weather reflect radar better than others. The intensity of a
radar reflection is not necessarily an indication of the weather hazard level. For
Sec 3
MFD
instance, wet hail returns a strong radar reflection, while dry hail does not. Both
wet and dry hail can be extremely hazardous.
The different NEXRAD echo intensities are measured in decibels (dB) relative
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
to reflectivity (Z). NEXRAD measures the radar reflectivity ratio, or the energy
reflected back to the radar receiver (designated by the letter Z). The value of Z
increases as the returned signal strength increases.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
4.7.5.2 NEXRAD Limitations
NEXRAD radar images may have certain limitations:
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
• NEXRAD composite reflectivity does not provide sufficient information
to determine cloud layers or precipitation characteristics. For example, it
is not possible to distinguish between wet snow, wet hail, and rain.
Symbols
Sec 7
the site.
Sec 8
NOTE: At present, NEXRAD data can age significantly by the time the
mosaic image is created. Although such situations are not believed to be
typical, in extreme latency and mosaic-creation scenarios, the actual age
of the oldest NEXRAD data in the mosaic can exceed the age indication
Sec 3
MFD
The Orientation option sets the orientation of the Wx Data Link Map pages.
1. While viewing the Wx Data Link Map 1, 2, or 3 of the Wx page group, press the
MENU key. With “Weather Setup” highlighted, press ENT.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
2. Turn the small MFD knob to select “Weather Setup 1/2” and press ENT.
3. With the “Map Orientation” option active, turn the small MFD knob to change
the highlighted value.
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
5. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the Navigation Map page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Foreword
where at and below the selected value NEXRAD weather products will be shown
on the selected MFD Wx Data Link Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off is selected,
NEXRAD weather data will not be shown. For the value (such as 100 NM) that
System
Sec 1
is selected, NEXRAD data will be shown at the selected map ranges (such as 100
NM) and lower.
1. While viewing a WX Data Link Map page of the WX page group, press the
Sec 2
MENU key to display the Page Menu Options. The cursor flashes on the
PFD
“Weather Setup” option. Press ENT.
2. Turn the small MFD knob to select “Weather Setup 1/2” and press ENT.
Sec 3
MFD
3. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight he NEXRAD Data Viewing Range value.
Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value.
Avoidance
4. Press ENT to accept the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
Hazard
Sec 4
5. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the previously viewed page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
4.7.8 NEXRAD Legend
The NEXRAD Legend selection provides the option of displaying an
abbreviated version of the NEXRAD legend in the top right region of the MFD.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
The full legend is available by pressing the LEGEND soft key. Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
3. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the Navigation Map page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Nexrad data.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
1. While viewing Weather Setup 1/2 menu, turn the large MFD knob to highlight
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
NOTE: Due to similarities in color schemes, the display of Echo Tops is
mutually exclusive with Cloud Tops and NEXRAD.
Echo Tops data shows the location, elevation, and direction of the highest
System
Sec 1
radar echo. The highest radar echo does not indicate the top of a storm or
clouds; rather it indicates the highest altitude at which precipitation is detected.
Information is derived from NEXRAD data.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Figure 4-43 XM Weather - Echo Tops
ECHO TOPS is selected. Areas where NEXRAD radar coverage and Echo Tops
information is not currently available or is not being collected are indicated in
grayish-purple.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
where at and below that value Echo Top weather products will be shown on the
selected MFD Wx Data Link Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off is selected, Echo
Tops will not be shown. Where a value (such as 250 NM) is selected, Echo Top
System
Sec 1
data will be shown at map ranges of the selected value (250 NM) and lower.
1. While viewing Weather Setup 1/2 menu, turn the large MFD knob to highlight
the Echo Top Data Viewing Range value.
Sec 2
PFD
2. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
Sec 3
MFD
3. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the previously viewed page, or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
NOTE: Due to similarities in color schemes, the display of Cloud Tops is
mutually exclusive with Echo Tops and NEXRAD.
Cloud Tops data depicts cloud top altitudes as determined from satellite
System
Sec 1
imagery.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 4-44 XM Weather - Cloud Tops
& Alerts
Annun.
To display the Cloud Tops legend, select the LEGEND soft key when Cloud
Sec 6
Tops is selected for display. Since Cloud Tops and Echo Tops use the same color
scaling to represent altitude, display of these weather products is mutually
Symbols
exclusive. When Cloud Tops is activated, Echo Tops or NEXRAD data is not
Sec 7
shown.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
range where at and below that value Cloud Top weather products will be shown
on the selected MFD Wx Data Link Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off is selected,
Cloud Tops will not be shown. Where a value (such as 150 NM) is selected,
System
Sec 1
Cloud Top data will be shown at map ranges of that value (150 NM) and lower.
1. While viewing Weather Setup 1/2 menu, turn the large MFD knob to highlight
the Cloud Top Data Viewing Range value.
Sec 2
PFD
2. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
3. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
Sec 3
MFD
the previously viewed page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
strikes. A strike icon represents a strike that has occurred within a two-kilometer
region. The exact location of the lightning strike is not displayed.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 4-45 XM Weather - Lightning
2. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
Appendix A
3. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the Navigation Map page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Index
and volcanic ash as issued by the National Weather Service. The update rate is
every 12 minutes.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
• Turbulence
• IFR conditions
• Mountain obscuration
Index
• Surface winds
Foreword
range where at and below that value SIGMET/AIRMET products will be shown
on the selected MFD Wx Data Link Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off is selected,
SIGMET/AIRMET will not be shown. Where a value (such as 100 NM) is
System
Sec 1
selected, SIGMET/AIRMET data will be shown at map ranges of the selected
value (100 NM) and lower.
1. While viewing Weather Setup 1/2 menu, turn the large MFD knob to highlight
Sec 2
PFD
the SIG/AIR Viewing Range value.
2. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
Sec 3
MFD
3. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the previously viewed page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Avoidance
Hazard
Viewing Textual Sigmet/Airmets
Sec 4
Textual Sigmet/Airmets can be viewed by selecting the Sigmet/Airmet outline
on the Weather (WX) page.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
1. While viewing a Map or Weather page, Use the small and large MFD knobs to
move the cursor to highlight a Sigmet/Airmet line. Press ENT.
2. The Sigmet/Airmet information will be shown. Press the small MFD knob to
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
return to the previously viewed page. Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
4.7.14 XM PIREPs
Pilot Weather Reports (PIREPs) provide timely weather information for a
Foreword
flight visibility, icing conditions, wind shear, and turbulence. PIREPs are issued
as either Routine (UA) or Urgent (UUA).
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
1. While viewing Weather Setup 1/2 menu, turn the large MFD knob to highlight
the PIREPs value.
Symbols
Sec 7
2. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
3. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
Glossary
Sec 8
the Navigation Map page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Appendix A
Index
4.7.15 XM METARs
NOTE: Atmospheric pressure reported for METARs is given in hectopascals
Foreword
(hPa), except in the United States, where it is reported in inches of mercury
(in Hg). Temperatures are reported in Celsius.
System
NOTE: METAR information is only displayed within the installed aviation
Sec 1
database service area.
Sec 2
PFD
Weather Report, is the standard format for current weather observations.
METARs are updated hourly and are considered current. METARs typically
contain information about the temperature, dew point, wind, precipitation,
Sec 3
cloud cover, cloud heights, visibility, and barometric pressure. They can also
MFD
contain information on precipitation amounts, lightning, and other critical data.
METARs are shown as colored flags at airports that provide them.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
The METAR Viewing Range option allows you to select the map range where
at and below that value METAR weather products will be shown on the selected
MFD Wx Data Link Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off is selected, METARs will
Index
not be shown. Where a value (such as 150 NM) is selected, METAR data will be
shown at map ranges of the selected value (150 NM) and lower.
1. While viewing Weather Setup 1/2 menu, turn the large MFD knob to highlight
the METAR Data Viewing Range value.
Foreword
2. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
3. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
System
Sec 1
the previously viewed page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Viewing Textual METARs
Sec 2
PFD
move the cursor to highlight an airport with a METAR flag. Press ENT.
2. The Waypoint Information page for that airport will now be shown. Press the
WX soft key to view weather information for the waypoint.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
3. Use the small MFD knob or the large MFD knob to scroll through the available
information.
4. Press the small MFD knob to return to the previously viewed page.
Index
Foreword
below that value Winds Aloft weather products will be shown on the selected
MFD Wx Data Link Map page (1, 2, or 3). Altitude can be selected in 3000 foot
increments from the surface up to 42,000 feet MSL. “ALT UNAVBL” is displayed
System
Sec 1
when the altitude is unsupported for a specific product and will never show data
on the map.
Pressing the WX Alt Dn or WX Alt Up soft keys steps down or up in the
Sec 2
PFD
3,000 foot increments. In the figure below where 9,000 feet is selected, Winds
Aloft data will be shown at 9,000 feet.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
range where at and below that value Winds Aloft weather products will appear
on the selected MFD Wx Data Link Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off is selected,
Winds Aloft will not be shown. Where a value (such as 100 NM) is selected,
System
Sec 1
Winds Aloft data will be shown at map ranges of the selected value (100 NM)
and lower.
1. While viewing Weather Setup 1/2 menu, turn the large MFD knob to highlight
Sec 2
PFD
3. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the previously viewed page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
NOTE: Surface Analysis and City Forecast data are displayed only within
the installed Aviation Database service area.
Surface Analysis and City Forecast information is available for current and
System
Sec 1
forecast weather conditions. Forecasts are available for intervals of 12, 24, 36,
and 48 hours by pressing the SRFC TIME soft key or in the Page Menu Weather
Setup options.
When enabled, the Surface Analysis forecast shows frontal lines indicat-
Sec 2
PFD
ing weather fronts and the direction they are moving. High and Low pressure
centers are noted with a large H or L. The Forecast Time menu item will step
through the intervals manually.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
A Cold Front is a front where cold air replaces warm air. A blue line with
Sec 8
blue triangles that point in the direction of the cold air flow.
Appendix A
A Stationary Front is a front with very little horizontal movement. The line
alternates with orange and blue sections which point in opposite directions to
Foreword
An Occluded Front is where a cold front has overtaken and merged with a
warm front. The line alternates with the blue triangle and orange half moon sym-
bols on the same side of the line pointing in the direction the front is moving.
Sec 2
PFD
The Surface Data Viewing Range option allows you to select the map range
where at and below that value Surface Data weather products will be shown on
Avoidance
Hazard
the selected MFD Wx Data Link Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off is selected,
Sec 4
Surface Data will not be shown. Where a value (such as 150 NM) is selected,
Surface data will be shown at map ranges of the selected value (150 NM) and
Additional
Features
lower.
Sec 5
1. While viewing Weather Setup 1/2 menu, turn the large MFD knob to highlight
the Surface Data Viewing Range value.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
2. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
3. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
Symbols
Sec 7
the previously viewed page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Forecast Time
Glossary
The Forecast Time option allows you to select the forecast time when the
Sec 8
Surface and City Forecast weather products will appear on the selected MFD Wx
Data Link Map page (1, 2, or 3). Forecasts are available for intervals of current,
Appendix A
12, 24, 36, and 48 hours. The interval is selected by pressing the FCST TIME
soft key on the Wx Data Link Map page.
Index
Foreword
warnings from the National Weather Service (NWS). This can include
information on fires, tornadoes, severe thunderstorms, flood conditions, and
other natural disasters.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 4-58 XM Weather - County Warnings
County Data Viewing Range
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
The County Data Viewing Range option allows you to select the map range
where at and below that value County weather products will be shown on the
selected MFD Wx Data Link Map pages (1, 2, or 3). When Off is selected, County
Symbols
Sec 7
Data will not be shown. Where a value (such as 100 NM) is selected, County
data will be shown at map ranges of the selected value (100 NM) and lower.
1. While viewing Weather Setup 1/2 menu, turn the large MFD knob to highlight
Glossary
Sec 8
4.7.19 XM TFRs
Temporary Flight Restrictions (TFRs) provide detailed information for local
Foreword
TFR Detail
To View Details
Sec 5
information will not be shown. For the value (such as 500 NM) selected, TFR
information will be shown at map ranges of that value (500 NM), and lower.
Glossary
Sec 8
1. While viewing Weather Setup 1/2 menu, turn the large MFD knob to highlight
the TFR Data Viewing Range option.
2. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
Appendix A
Foreword
pages.
1. While viewing a XM Weather page, Use the small and large MFD knobs to
move the cursor to highlight a TFR symbol (yellow circle). Press ENT.
System
Sec 1
2. The TFR details will be shown.
3. Press the small MFD knob or ENT to return to the Weather page.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Figure 4-60 XM Weather - Textual TFRs and Legend
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
selected independently.
Sec 6
range and below where Cell Movement weather products will appear on the
selected MFD Wx Data Link Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off is selected, Cell
Movement will not be shown. Where a value (such as 100 NM) is selected, Cell
Glossary
Sec 8
Movement data will be shown at map ranges of the selected value (100 NM)
and lower.
Appendix A
1. While viewing Weather Setup 2/2 menu, turn the large MFD knob to highlight
the Cell Movement Data Viewing Range option.
2. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
Index
3. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the previously viewed page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
4-82 Garmin G500/G600 Pilot’s Guide 190-00601-02 Rev. J
TOC Cover
4.7.21 XM AIREPs
Air Reports (AIREPs) are messages from an aircraft, typically from commercia
Foreword
aircraft, to a ground station. AIREPs are similar to PIREPs.
1. While viewing Weather Setup 2/2 menu, turn the large MFD knob to highlight
the AIREPs Viewing Range option.
System
Sec 1
2. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
Sec 2
3. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
PFD
the previously viewed page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
2. Press ENT to view text information. Press ENT again to return to the previous page.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
4.7.22 XM Cyclone
The current location of the cyclone is shown along with its projected path
Foreword
with the date and time.
1. While viewing Weather Setup 2/2 menu, turn the large MFD knob to highlight
System
the Cyclone Data Viewing Range option.
Sec 1
2. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
Sec 2
PFD
3. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the previously viewed page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Projected Path With Date
And Time
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Current Position Of Cyclone Symbols
Sec 7
location at which the Freezing Level is found. When no data is displayed for a
given altitude, the data for that altitude has not been received, or is out of date
and has been removed from the display. New data appears at the next update.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
The Freezing Level Viewing Range option allows you to select the map range
where at and below that value Freezing Level weather products will be shown
on the selected MFD Wx Data Link Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off is selected,
Symbols
Sec 7
Freezing Level Data will not be shown. Where a value (such as 100 NM) is
selected, Freezing Level data will be shown at map ranges of the selected value
(100 NM) and lower.
Glossary
Sec 8
1. While viewing Weather Setup 2/2 menu, turn the large MFD knob to highlight
the Frz Lvl Viewing Range value.
Appendix A
2. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
3. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the previously viewed page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Index
4.7.24 XM Icing
The Icing product shows a graphic view of the current icing environment
Foreword
in four categories: light, moderate, severe, and extreme (not specific to aircraft
type). The Icing product is not a forecast, but a presentation of the current
conditions at the time of the analysis. Supercooled Large Droplet (SLD) icing
System
conditions are characterized by the presence of relatively large, super cooled
Sec 1
water droplets indicative of freezing drizzle and freezing rain aloft. SLD threat
areas are depicted as black and red blocks over the Icing colors. Icing and SLD
data are shown between 1,000 feet and 30,000 feet in 3,000 foot increments.
Sec 2
PFD
1. While viewing Weather Setup 2/2 menu, turn the large MFD knob to highlight
the Icing Data Viewing Range value.
2. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
Sec 3
MFD
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
3. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
the Navigation Map page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
4.7.25 XM Turbulence
Turbulence data identifies the potential for erratic movement of high-altitude
Foreword
1. While viewing Weather Setup 2/2 menu, turn the large MFD knob to highlight
the Turbulence Viewing Range value.
Sec 2
2. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
PFD
the previously viewed page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
4. Press the WX Alt Dn or WX Alt Up keys to increase or decrease the
reporting altitude of icing in 3,000 foot increments. The selected altitude
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
The G500/G600 can display weather radar from a Garmin GWX system or
from selected 3rd-party radars. Only one weather radar system may be interfaced
to the system. For detailed information on the operation of 3rd-party radars,
System
refer to their specific documentation.
Sec 1
4.8.1 Garmin Weather Radar Description
The Garmin GWX 68 and GWX 70 Airborne Color Weather Radars combine
Sec 2
PFD
excellent range and adjustable scanning profiles with a high-definition target
display.
To focus radar scanning on specific areas, Sector Scanning offers pilot-
Sec 3
MFD
adjustable horizontal scan angles of 20º, 40º, 60º, or 90º (up to 120º with the
GWX 70). A vertical scanning function helps to analyze storm tops, gradients,
Avoidance
and cell buildup activity at various altitudes.
Hazard
Sec 4
Refer to the documentation of each radar for specific features.
4.8.1.1 Synchronized Radar - GWX 68 Only
Additional
Features
Sec 5
The GWX 68 synchronizes the following radar functions across all connected
displays.
• Mode • Tilt
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
• Range • On/Off controls
• Bearing
Symbols
Sec 7
sweeps. In the case when two displays have the same radar settings, the radar
sweep is identical on both displays.
Changes made to the following functions affect only the associated display.
System
Sec 1
• Mode • Tilt
• Range • On/Off controls
• Bearing
Sec 2
PFD
For example, the operating mode may be switched to Weather on one display,
while Ground Mapping mode is enabled on another.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Figure 4-67 Weather Radar Display Figure 4-68 Ground Mapping Display
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
When the GWX 70 is turned off on all displays, the “OFF” message appears
on the Advisory page of the GDU.
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Figure 4-69 Radar Off Advisory
Additional
Features
If the GWX 70 is turned off on the GDU, but another display is still actively
Sec 5
scanning, the “RADAR ACTIVE” advisory appears.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
the most intense energy in the center of the beam and decreasing intensity near
Sec 1
the edge. The same antenna is used for both transmitting and receiving. The
returned signal is then processed and displayed on the G500/G600 MFD.
Radar detection is a two-way process that requires 12.36 micro-seconds for
Sec 2
PFD
the transmitted microwave pulses to travel out and back for each nautical mile
of target range. It takes 123.6 micro-seconds for a transmitted pulse to make the
round trip if a target is 10 NM away.
Sec 3
MFD
The GWX weather radar should be used to avoid severe weather, not for
penetrating severe weather. The decision to fly into an area of radar targets
Avoidance
Hazard
depends on target intensity, spacing between the targets, aircraft capabilities and
Sec 4
pilot experience. Pulse type weather radar detects only precipitation, not clouds
or turbulence. The display may indicate clear areas between intense returns, but
Additional
this does not necessarily mean it is safe to fly between them. Only Doppler radar
Features
Sec 5
also has the ability to detect and provide distance to objects on the ground, such
Sec 6
Foreword
The radar beam is much like the beam of a spotlight. The farther the beam
travels, the wider it gets. The radar is only capable of “seeing” what is inside the
boundaries of the beam.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Figure 4-71 Radar Beam from 12 inch Antenna
Avoidance
The vertical dimensions of the radar beam are shown in the figure above and
Hazard
Sec 4
the same holds true for the horizontal dimensions. In other words, the beam will
be as wide as it is tall. Note that it is possible not to see areas of precipitation on
the radar display because of the antenna tilt setting. With the antenna tilt set to
Additional
Features
Sec 5
zero in this illustration, the beam overshoots the precipitation at 15 NM. The
curvature of the earth can also be a factor, especially at range settings of 150 NM
or more.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
320 nm
Glossary
Sec 8
Attenuation because of distance is due to the fact that the amount of radar
energy at a distance from the antenna is inversely proportional to the square of
the distance. The reflected radar energy from a target 40 miles away that fills the
Sec 2
PFD
radar beam will be one fourth the energy reflected from an equivalent target 20
miles away. This would appear to the operator that the storm is gaining intensity
as the aircraft gets closer. Internal circuitry within the GWX system compensates
Sec 3
MFD
of the radar energy is reflected back to the antenna. However, much of the
energy is absorbed. If precipitation is very heavy, or covers a large area, the
signal may not reach completely through the area of precipitation. The weather
Additional
Features
precipitation. If the signal has been fully attenuated, the radar will display a
“radar shadow.” This appears as an end to the precipitation when, in fact, the
& Alerts
Annun.
heavy rain may extend much further. A cell containing heavy precipitation may
Sec 6
block another cell located behind the first, preventing it from being displayed
on the radar. Never fly into these shadowed areas and never assume that all of
the heavy precipitation is being displayed unless another cell or a ground target
Symbols
Sec 7
can be seen beyond the heavy cell. The WATCH™ feature of the GWX Weather
Radar system can help in identifying these shadowed areas. Areas in question
will appear as “shadowed” or gray area on the radar display. Proper use of the
Glossary
Sec 8
radome. Even the smallest amount of wear and tear, pitting, and pinholes on the
radome surface can cause damage and system inefficiency.
Index
Foreword
Precipitation or objects more dense than water, such as earth or solid
structures, will be detected by the weather radar. The weather radar will not
detect clouds, thunderstorms or turbulence directly. It detects precipitation
System
Sec 1
associated with clouds, thunderstorms, and turbulence. The best radar signal
reflectors are raindrops, wet snow or wet hail. The larger the raindrop the
better it reflects. The size of the precipitation droplet is the most important
Sec 2
PFD
factor in radar reflectivity. Because large drops in a small concentrated area are
characteristic of a severe thunderstorm, the radar displays the storm as a strong
return. Ice, dry snow, and dry hail have low reflective levels and often will not be
Sec 3
MFD
displayed by the radar. A cloud that contains only small raindrops, such as fog
or drizzle, will not reflect enough radar energy to produce a measurable target
return.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
radar beam strikes the ground target (Angle of Incidence) and the reflective
properties of that target. The gain can be adjusted so shorelines, rivers, lakes,
and cities are well defined. Increasing gain too much causes the display to fill in
System
Sec 1
radar beam by the taller buildings. As the aircraft approaches, and shorter ranges
are selected, details become more noticeable as the highly reflective regular lines
and edges of the city become more defined.
Sec 3
MFD
Bodies of water such as lakes, rivers, and oceans are not good reflectors,
and normally do not provide good returns. The energy is reflected in a forward
scatter angle with inadequate energy being returned. They can appear as dark
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
areas on the display. However, rough or choppy water is a better reflector and
will provide stronger returns from the downwind sides of the waves.
Mountains also provide strong return signals to the antenna, but also block
Additional
Features
Sec 5
the areas behind. However, over mountainous terrain, the radar beam can be
reflected back and forth in the mountain passes or off canyon walls using up all
or most of the radar energy. In this case, no return signal is received from
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
this area causing the display to show a dark spot which could indicate a
pass where no pass exists.
4.8.2.3 Angle of Incidence
Symbols
Sec 7
The angle at which the radar beam strikes the target is called the Angle of
Incidence. Incident angle (“A”) is illustrated below. This directly affects the
detectable range, the area of illumination, and the intensity of the displayed
Glossary
Sec 8
target returns. A large incident angle gives the radar system a smaller detectable
range and lower display intensity due to minimized reflection of the radar energy.
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Figure 4-74 Angle of Incidence
Sec 3
MFD
A smaller incident angle gives the radar a larger detectable range of operation
and the target display will show a higher intensity. Since more radar energy is
reflected back to the antenna with a low incident angle, the resulting detectable
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
range is increased for mountainous terrain.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
The following information establishes a minimum safe distance from the
antenna for personnel near an operating airborne weather radar. The minimum
safe distance is based upon the FCC’s exposure limit at 9.3 to 9.5 GHz for general
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
population/uncontrolled environments which is 1 mW/cm2. See Advisory
Circular 20-68B for more information on safe distance determination.
4.8.3.1 Maximum Permissible Exposure Level (GWX 68)
Symbols
Sec 7
The zone in which the radiation level exceeds the US Government standard
of 1 mW/cm2, is the semicircular area of at least 11 feet from the 12 inch antenna
as indicated in the illustration below. All personnel must remain outside of
Glossary
Sec 8
this zone. With a scanning or rotating beam, the averaged power density at
the Maximum Permissible Exposure Level (MPEL) boundary is significantly
reduced.
Appendix A
MPEL
Foreword
Boundary
System
Sec 1
The following discussion is a simple method for setting up the weather radar
antenna tilt for most situations. It is not to be considered an all encompassing
setup that will work in all situations, but this method does provide good overall
Additional
Features
Sec 5
With the aircraft flying level, adjust the antenna tilt so ground returns are
displayed at a distance that equals the aircraft’s current altitude (AGL) divided
by 1,000. For example, if the aircraft is at 14,000 feet, adjust the tilt so the front
Symbols
edge of ground returns are displayed at 14 NM. Note this antenna tilt angle
Sec 7
setting. Now, raise the antenna tilt 6º above this setting. The bottom of the radar
beam is now angled down 4º from parallel with the ground.
Glossary
Sec 8
any displayed target return should scrutinized. If the displayed target advances
on the screen to 5 NM of the aircraft, avoid it. This may be either weather or
ground returns that are 2,000 feet or less below the aircraft. Raising the antenna
tilt 4º can help separate ground returns from weather returns in relatively flat
Index
terrain. This will place the bottom of the radar beam level with the ground.
Return the antenna tilt to the previous setting after a few sweeps.
If the aircraft is above 29,000 feet, be cautious of any target return that gets
to 30 NM or closer. This is likely a thunderstorm that has a top high enough that
Foreword
the aircraft cannot fly over it safely.
If the aircraft altitude is 15,000 feet or lower, set the displayed range to
60 NM. Closely monitor anything that enters the display.
System
Sec 1
Also, after setting up the antenna tilt angle as described previously, ground
returns can be monitored for possible threats. The relationship between antenna
tilt angle, altitude, and distance is one degree of tilt equals 100 feet of altitude
Sec 2
PFD
for every one nautical mile.
4000
Sec 3
MFD
+4° 2000
+3°
+2° 1000
+1°
0° 0
Avoidance
-1°
Hazard
-2° 1000
Sec 4
-3°
-4° 2000
3000
4000
Additional
Features
10 nm
Sec 5
Figure 4-76 Vertical Change in Radar Beam per Nautical Mile
Therefore, with the antenna tilt set so that the bottom of the beam is four
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
degrees below parallel with the ground, a target return at 10 NM is approximately
4,000 feet below the aircraft; at 20 NM, 8,000 feet; at 50 NM, 20,000 feet. In
other words, at this tilt setting, a ground return (such as a mountain peak) being
Symbols
Sec 7
This setup will provide a good starting point for practical use of the GWX
radar. There are many other factors to consider in order to become proficient at
using weather radar in all situations.
Appendix A
When evaluating various target returns on the weather radar display, the
colors denote approximate rainfall intensity and rates as shown in the table
below.
190-00601-02 Rev. J Garmin G500/G600 Pilot’s Guide 4-99
Cover TOC
3rd Party
GWX 68 Radars GWX 70 Radars
Radars
Foreword
(in/hr) mentation
Sec 1
for details)
BLACK < 23 dBZ < .01 < 23 dBZ 0
GREEN 23 dBZ to < 33 dBZ .01 - 0.1 23 dBZ to < 33 dBZ 1
Sec 2
PFD
4.8.5.2 Thunderstorms
Hazard
Sec 4
droplets. With this in mind, the following interpretations can be made from what
Features
Sec 5
is displayed on the weather radar. Avoid these areas by an extra wide margin.
• In areas where the displayed target intensity is red or magenta (indicating
large amounts of precipitation), the turbulence is considered severe.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
• Areas that show steep color gradients (intense color changes) over thin bands
or short distances suggest irregular rainfall rate and strong turbulence.
Symbols
• Areas that show red or magenta are associated with hail or turbulence, as
Sec 7
Squall Line
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Steep Gradient
Sec 2
PFD
Hook or Finger Scalloped Edge
Figure 4-77 Cell Irregularities
Thunderstorm development is rapid. A course may become blocked within a
Sec 3
MFD
short time. When displaying shorter ranges, periodically select a longer range to
see if problems are developing further out. That can help prevent getting trapped
in a “blind alley” or an area that is closed at one end by convective weather.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
In areas of multiple heavy cells, use the Vertical Scan feature along with
antenna tilt management to examine the areas. Remember to avoid shadowed
Glossary
4.8.5.3 Tornadoes
There is no conclusive radar target return characteristics which will identify
Foreword
• A “hook” which may be in the general shape of the numeral “6,” especially
if bright and projecting from the southwest quadrant (northeast quadrant in
the southern hemisphere) of a major thunderstorm.
Sec 2
PFD
• V- shaped notches.
• Doughnut shapes.
Sec 3
MFD
These shapes do not always indicate tornadoes, nor are tornado returns
limited to these characteristics. Confirmed radar observations of tornadoes most
often have not shown shapes different from those of a normal thunderstorm
Avoidance
Hazard
display.
Sec 4
4.8.5.4 Hail
Hail results from updrafts carrying water high enough to freeze. Therefore,
Additional
Features
the higher the top of a thunderstorm, the greater the probability that it contains
Sec 5
hail. Vertically scanning the target return can give the radar top of a thunderstorm
that contains hail. Radar top is the top of a storm cell as detected by radar. It is
not the actual top, or true top of the storm. The actual top of a storm cell is seen
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
with the eyes in clear air and may be much higher than the radar top. The actual
top does not indicate the top of the hazardous area.
Symbols
Hail can fall below the minimum reflectivity threshold for radar detection.
Sec 7
It can have a film of water on its surface, making its reflective characteristics
similar to a very large water droplet. Because of this film of water, and because
hail stones usually are larger than water droplets, thunderstorms with large
Glossary
Sec 8
amounts of wet hail return stronger signals than those with rain. Some hail
shafts are extremely narrow (100 yards or less) and make poor radar targets. In
the upper regions of a cell where ice particles are “dry” (no liquid coating), target
Appendix A
These target returns appear quite suddenly along any edge of the cell outline.
They also change in intensity and shape in a matter of seconds, making vigilant
monitoring essential.
4-102 Garmin G500/G600 Pilot’s Guide 190-00601-02 Rev. J
TOC Cover
Foreword
WARNING: Begin transmitting only when it is safe to do so. When
transmitting while the aircraft is on the ground, no personnel or objects
should be within 11 feet of the antenna.
System
Sec 1
CAUTION: In Standby mode, the antenna is parked at the center line. It
is always a good idea to put the radar in Standby mode before taxiing the
aircraft to prevent the antenna from bouncing on the bottom stop and
possibly causing damage to the radar assembly.
Sec 2
PFD
When the weather radar system is in the Weather or Ground Map mode, the
system automatically switches to Standby mode on landing.
Sec 3
Antenna
MFD
Operating
Mode Stabilization
Avoidance
Weather Alert
Hazard
Sec 4
(GWX Only)
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Precipitation Control
Sec 7
Scale Window
Glossary
Sec 8
NOTE: Distances on the Weather Radar page are always shown in NM.
1. While viewing the Weather Radar page of the Wx page group, press the MODE
soft key.
System
Sec 1
2. While on the ground, press the STANDBY soft key. A warm-up period is
initiated (countdown is displayed on the screen - GWX radars only). After the
warm-up is complete, the radar enters the Standby Mode.
Sec 2
PFD
2. Turn the large MFD Knob to highlight YES and press the ENT key to continue
radar activation.
OR
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
1. If the aircraft is airborne, select the WEATHER soft key. A warm-up period is
initiated (countdown is displayed on the screen - GWX radars only). After the
Symbols
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Figure 4-82 Vertical Scan Display
Additional
Features
Sec 5
4.8.6.2 Vertically Scanning a Storm Cell
(Not available with all radars)
& Alerts
When vertically scanning with stabilization ON, the actual physical area
Annun.
Sec 6
that the radar is sweeping may not match the GDU vertical scan display. This
occurs whenever the aircraft pitch is not at 0 degrees. To compensate for this,
the GDU vertical display will “erase” the portion of the vertical display that is
Symbols
Sec 7
no longer being scanned. It will appear that the vertical sweep “wraps around”
when reaching the end of the GDU vertical display. The radar is simply “erasing”
the portion of the vertical display that is not currently being scanned.
Glossary
Sec 8
NOTE: Vertical scanning of a storm cell should be done with the aircraft
wings level to avoid constant adjustment of the Bearing Line.
Appendix A
Index
1. While in the Horizontal Scan view, press the CONTROL and then the BRG soft
keys. This displays the Bearing Line.
Foreword
OR
Press MENU and turn the large or small MFD knobs to highlight the “Show
Bearing Line” menu item and press the ENT key. This displays the Bearing
System
Sec 1
Line.
2. Press the MFD knob to activate the Bearing Line Adjustment in the Control
window. Turn the Large MFD knob to highlight the Bearing value.
Sec 2
PFD
3. Turn the small MFD knob to place the Bearing Line on the desired storm cell or
other area to be vertically scanned.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
5. With the Bearing value still highlighted, the small MFD Knob may be used to
move the scanned “slice” a few degrees right or left.
6. Press the RNG keys to adjust the range.
Symbols
Sec 7
should be pointed at the wet part of the weather cell to record the proper rainfall
intensity (color level). The ideal aiming point is just below the freezing level of
the storm. The best way to find this point is to use the Vertical Scan feature. The
antenna tilt angle can be centered on the strongest return area in the vertical
Index
scan to get a more accurate view of the coverage and intensity of the target in
the horizontal scan.
Foreword
2. With the Tilt value highlighted in the Control window, turn the small MFD knob
to adjust the Tilt.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Figure 4-84 Adjusting Tilt
Sec 3
MFD
Adjusting Antenna Tilt on the Vertical Scan Display
(Not available with all radars)
Avoidance
1. While in the Vertical Scan view, press the CONTROL and then the TILT soft
Hazard
Sec 4
keys. This displays the Tilt Line.
OR
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Press MENU and turn the large or small MFD knobs to highlight the “Show Tilt
Line” menu item and press the ENT key. This displays the Tilt Line.
2. Press the MFD knob to activate the Tilt Adjustment in the Control window. Turn
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
the large MFD knob to highlight the Tilt value.
3. Turn the small MFD knob to adjust the Tilt value.
Symbols
Sec 7
Gain adjustment is shown in the Gain bar graph. The white reference line on
the right side of the bar graph indicates the calibration reference point.
Appendix A
NOTE: Gain can be adjusted in Weather mode on the GWX radars only.
1. While viewing the Weather Radar page of the Wx page group, press the MENU
key.
Foreword
2. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight “Manual Gain” and press ENT. This will
highlight the Gain value in the Control window.
3. Turn the small MFD knob to adjust the Gain.
System
Sec 1
OR
1. Press the MFD knob and turn the large MFD knob to highlight the Gain value
Sec 2
Symbols
Sec 7
1. While viewing the Weather Radar page of the Wx page group, press the MENU
key.
Appendix A
2. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight “Restore Calibrated Gain” and press
ENT.
Index
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
Figure 4-87 Restore Calibrated Gain
PFD
OR
1. While viewing the Weather Radar page of the Wx page group, press the
Sec 3
MFD
CONTROL soft key.
2. Press the GAIN CAL soft key to restore the calibrated gain value. Press the
Avoidance
MFD knob again to accept the value and end editing.
Hazard
Sec 4
4.8.6.5 Sector Scan - GWX Radars Only
Adjusting the Sector Scan reduces the scan angle from Full in increments of
Additional
Features
Sec 5
±20°, ±40°, and ±60° in horizontal scanning. Sector scanning is not available for
vertical scanning.
1. While viewing the Weather Radar page of the Wx page group, press the
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
CONTROL soft key.
2. Press the BRG soft key to display the Bearing Line.
Symbols
Sec 7
3. Turn the small MFD knob to place the Bearing Line in the desired position. The
location of the Bearing Line will become the center point of the Sector Scan.
4. Turn the large MFD knob to place the cursor in the SECTOR SCAN field.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
5. Turn the small MFD knob to select FULL, 60°, 40°, or 20° scan.
Foreword
System
Sec 1
The current stabilization condition is shown in the upper right of the weather
radar display.
& Alerts
Annun.
distance. Issues with the radome will also attenuate the radar energy. All these
Sec 8
factors have an effect on the return intensity. The more energy that dissipates, the
lesser the displayed intensity of the return. Accuracy of the displayed intensity
Appendix A
of returns located in the shaded areas are suspect. Make maneuvering decisions
with this information in mind. Proper antenna tilt management should still be
employed to determine the extent of attenuation in a shaded area.
1. While viewing the Weather Radar page of the Wx page group, press the
Index
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Figure 4-90 Horizontal Scan without WATCH™ Figure 4-91 Horizontal Scan with WATCH™
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
4.8.6.8 Weather Alert - GWX Radars Only
The Weather Alert feature indicates the presence of heavy radar returns
Additional
beyond the currently displayed range. Weather Alert targets appear as red bands
Features
Sec 5
along the outer range ring at the approximate azimuth of the detected returns.
If the antenna tilt is adjusted too low, a weather alert can be generated by
ground returns.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Weather Alerts Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
will be displayed on the MFD in the Alerts Window. These text Weather Alerts
can be deactivated without deactivating the red bands on the radar display.
1. While viewing the Weather Radar page of the Wx page group, press the MENU
key.
Index
2. To activate or deactivate Weather Alerts, turn the large or small MFD knob to
highlight either “Enable Weather Alert” or “Inhibit Weather Alert.”
190-00601-02 Rev. J Garmin G500/G600 Pilot’s Guide 4-111
Cover TOC
1. While viewing the Weather Radar Menu, turn the small or large MFD knob to
highlight Enable Ground Clutter Suppression (GCS) and then press ENT.
Foreword
2. To deactivate Ground Clutter Suppression, repeat the sequence.
System
Sec 1
A secondary use of the weather radar system is for the presentation of terrain.
This can be a useful tool for verifying aircraft position. A “picture” of the ground
is represented much like a topographical map that can be used as a supplement
Sec 2
PFD
to the navigation map on the MFD.
Ground Map mode uses a different gain range than Weather mode. Different
colors are also used to represent the intensity levels. The displayed intensity of
Sec 3
MFD
ground target returns are defined in the following table. Use of the GAIN and
TILT controls will help improve contrast so that specific ground targets can be
recognized more easily. As previously discussed, the type and orientation of the
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
target in relation to the aircraft affects the intensity displayed.
Ground Map 3rd Party Radars
GWX Radars Intensity
Mode Color Level
Additional
Features
Sec 5
BLACK 0 dB 0
LIGHT BLUE > 0 dB to < 9 dB 1
YELLOW 9 dB to < 18 dB 2
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
MAGENTA 18 dB to < 27 dB 3 and above
BLUE 27 dB and greater Not Used
Table 4-27 Ground Target Return Intensity Levels
Symbols
Sec 7
5. Turn the large MFD knob to place the cursor in the TILT field.
6. Adjust the antenna tilt angle by turning the small MFD knob to display ground
Foreword
the Weather Data Link Pages in the Map Page Group. These are the only
GDU 620 map displays capable of all available GFDS weather products.
The Wx Weather pages may be oriented to either Track Up or North Up.
Sec 3
More detail on GFDS weather products and coverage can be found at:
http://fly.garmin.com/fly-garmin/gfds-weather/
Additional
Features
Sec 5
NOTE: A system can be configured for both XM and GFDS, but both cannot
be displayed a the same time.
WARNING: Do not use data link weather information for maneuvering in,
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
WARNING: Do not use the indicated data link weather product age to
determine the age of the weather information shown by the data link
weather product. Due to time delays inherent in gathering and processing
weather data for data link transmission, the weather information shown by
Glossary
Sec 8
the data link weather product may be significantly older than the indicated
weather product age.
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
It is necessary to register the GDU with GFDS to utilize the weather products.
1. Call Garmin Customer Service to create a GFDS account. Provide the GDU
System ID and airframe info (model, tail number, etc).
System
Sec 1
2. Customer Service will issue an access code to enter on the GFDS Registration page.
3. While viewing a WX Map page of the WX page group, press the MENU key to
display the Page Menu Options.
Sec 2
PFD
4. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight “Register With GFDS.” Press ENT.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Figure 4-95 Select GFDS Registration
Sec 5
5. Turn the small MFD knob to select values and the large MFD knob to move to
the next position. Highlight REGISTER and press ENT to complete the process.
The GDU will contact the GFDS servers using the GSR 56 transceiver. If the access
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
code and system ID are correct, it will download and display the airframe info. Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
no longer make requests to GFDS. This does not cancel the subscription.
1. While viewing a WX Map page of the WX page group, press the MENU key to
display the Page Menu Options.
System
Sec 1
2. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight “Register With GFDS.” Press ENT.
3. With the Access Code field highlighted, press CLR to remove the access code.
4. Any weather requests will now fail and the system will no longer be linked to the
Sec 2
PFD
GFDS account.
4.9.2 Using GFDS Satellite Weather Products
Sec 3
MFD
When a weather product is active on the Weather Data Link Page or the
Navigation Map Page, the age of the data is displayed on the screen. The age of
the product is based on the time difference between when the data was assembled
Avoidance
Hazard
on the ground and the current GPS time. Weather products are refreshed at
Sec 4
selectable intervals.
If for any reason, a weather product is not refreshed within the 30, 60, 90,
Additional
or 120 minute Expiration Time intervals, the data is considered expired and is
Features
Sec 5
removed from the display. This ensures that the displayed data is consistent with
what is currently being broadcast by GFDS Satellite Radio services. If more than
half of the expiration time has elapsed from the time the data is received, the
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Each Wx Map page may be customized individually. The Wx Map pages are
customized by selecting options from the Page Menu. The Page Menu options
include choices for Weather Setup and displaying the Weather Legends. The
Glossary
Weather Setup choice covers selections for adjusting the viewing ranges of the
Sec 8
weather products.
Appendix A
1. While viewing a WX Map page of the WX page group, press the MENU key
to display the Page Menu Options. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight the
Foreword
“Weather Setup” option. Press ENT.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Figure 4-97 Weather Page Menu Options
2. With the Weather Setup Menu displayed, turn the Large MFD knob to select
Sec 3
MFD
the desired item.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
5. Turn the large MFD knob to the next desired option or press the small MFD
knob to cancel and return to the GFDS Weather Data Link Map Page.
Index
1. While viewing a WX Map page of the WX page group, press the MENU key to
display the Page Menu Options.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
2. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight “GFDS Data Request.” Press ENT.
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
3. Turn the small MFD knob to select values and the large MFD knob to move to
the next position.
Index
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Figure 4-100 GFDS Data Request Page
Additional
4.9.4.1 GFDS Data Request Coverage
Features
Sec 5
Present Position GFDS Data Request
1. While viewing a WX Data Link Map page of the WX page group, press the
& Alerts
Annun.
MENU key to display the Page Menu Options.
Sec 6
2. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight “GFDS Data Request.” Press ENT.
3. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight “Present Position.” Press ENT.
Symbols
Sec 7
4. The Present Position box will be checked and weather information will be
requested around your present position.
Glossary
Sec 8
5. To deselect Present Position reporting, turn the large MFD knob to highlight
“Present Position.” Press ENT.
Appendix A
Index
2. The Destination box will be checked and weather information will be requested
around your flight plan destination.
3. To deselect Destination reporting, turn the large MFD knob to highlight
System
Sec 1
1. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight “Flight Plan.” Press ENT.
2. The range list will now be highlighted. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight
the desired range and press ENT.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
4. To deselect Flight Plan reporting, turn the large MFD knob to highlight “Flight
Plan.” Press ENT.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
2. The Waypoint Selection field will now be highlighted. Turn the small MFD
knob to select the first character. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight the
next character. When finished selecting the waypoint name, press ENT.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Figure 4-102 Waypoint GFDS Data Request
Symbols
Sec 7
3. The Waypoint box will be checked and weather information will be requested
around the selected waypoint for the range selected (next operation).
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
2. Turn the small MFD knob to select the desired Diameter/Route Width and then
press ENT.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
2. Turn the small MFD knob to select “Off” or an Update Rate. When finished
selecting the Update Rate, press ENT. The Update Rate will default to “OFF”
at each power cycle.
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Foreword
update timing by selecting a Manual Request. When multiple requests are made,
some products are merged with the old data (SIGMETs/AIRMETs, TAFs, TFRs,
and METARs), but the old data of other products is discarded.
System
Sec 1
1. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight “Manual Request - Send Req.”
2. Press ENT.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Figure 4-105 Manual GFDS Data Request
3. The update request will occur immediately. The action will be noted in the
Request Status window. The Auto Request time will be reset to the selected
Additional
Features
Sec 5
value.
& Alerts
Annun.
The Request Status window will show a response such as “OK” when manual
Sec 6
requests are made. The time for the next auto update will be shown.
The Orientation option sets the orientation of the Wx Data Link Map pages.
1. While viewing the GFDS Weather Map 1, 2, or 3 of the Wx page group, press
the MENU key. With “Weather Setup” highlighted, press ENT.
Glossary
Sec 8
2. With the “Map Orientation” option active, turn the small MFD knob to change
the highlighted value.
Appendix A
3. Press ENT to accept the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
4. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the WX page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Index
map range where at and below the selected value PRECIP weather products will
be shown on the selected MFD Wx Data Link Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off
is selected, PRECIP weather data will not be shown. In the figure below where
System
500 NM is selected, PRECIP data will be shown at map ranges of 500 NM and
Sec 1
lower. TFRs and METARs are the only weather products shown below 10 NM.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Coverage Boundary
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
1. While viewing a WX Data Link Map page of the WX page group, press the
MENU key to display the Page Menu Options. The Weather Setup option will
Glossary
Sec 8
the WX page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Foreword
version of the PRECIP legend in the top right region of the MFD. The full legend
is available by pressing the LEGEND soft key.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Figure 4-107 GFDS PRECIP Legend
Sec 3
MFD
1. While viewing a GFDS Weather Map page of the WX page group, press the
MENU key to display the Page Menu Options. The Weather Setup option will
be highlighted. Press ENT.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
2. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight PRECIP Legend.
3. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight Off or On. Press ENT to accept the
Additional
Features
displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
Sec 5
4. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the WX page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
and depicts cloud top temperatures from satellite imagery. Brighter cloud top
colors indicate cooler temperatures occurring at higher altitudes. Information is
updated every half hour.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 4-108 GFDS Infrared Satellite Data Map Display and Legend
IR SAT Data Viewing Range
The IR SAT Data Viewing Range option allows you to select the map range
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
where at and below that value IR SAT weather products will be shown on the
selected MFD GFDS Weather Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off is selected, IR SAT
will not be shown. For the selected value (such as 250 NM) is selected, IR SAT
Symbols
Sec 7
data will be shown at map ranges of the selected value (250 NM) and lower.
1. While viewing a GFDS Weather Map page of the WX page group, press the
MENU key to display the Page Menu Options. Turn the large MFD knob to
Glossary
Sec 8
3. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
4. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
Index
the WX page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Foreword
cloud-to-ground lightning strikes. A strike icon represents a strike that has
occurred within a two-kilometer region. The exact location of the lightning
strike is not displayed. Only cloud to ground strikes are reported in the US and
System
extreme southern Canada (cloud to cloud strikes are not reported).
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 4-109 GFDS Data Link Lightning and Legend
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
The Lightning Data Viewing Range option allows you to select the map range where
at and below that value Lightning weather products will be shown on the selected MFD
GFDS Weather Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off is selected, Lightning will not be shown.
Symbols
Where a value (such as 250 NM) is selected, GFDS data will be shown at map
Sec 7
MENU key to display the Page Menu Options. Turn the large MFD knob to
Sec 8
3. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
4. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
Index
the WX page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
IFR Line
Sec 3
MFD
SIGMET Line
Additional
Features
Icing
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
every 12 minutes in the U.S. Elsewhere, updates are made as they are issued.
Viewing Textual SIGMETs/AIRMETs
Appendix A
2. The Waypoint Information page for that line will now be shown. Press the WX
soft key to view weather information.
4-128 Garmin G500/G600 Pilot’s Guide 190-00601-02 Rev. J
TOC Cover
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Figure 4-111 GFDS Weather - AIRMETs/SIGMETs Detail and Legend
When enabled, the following AIRMETs are available for display:
Additional
Features
• Icing
Sec 5
• Turbulence
• IFR conditions
• Mountain obscuration
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
• Surface winds Symbols
The SIGMET/AIRMET Viewing Range option allows you to select the map
range where at and below that value SIGMET/AIRMET products will be shown
on the selected MFD Wx Data Link Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off is selected,
Glossary
Sec 8
1. While viewing a WX Data Link Map page of the WX page group, press the
MENU key to display the Page Menu Options. Turn the large MFD knob to
Foreword
4.9.11 AIREP/PIREP
Pilot Weather Reports (PIREPs) provide timely weather information for a
Sec 3
MFD
flight visibility, icing conditions, wind shear, and turbulence. PIREPs are issued
as either Routine (UA) or Urgent (UUA).
Product Age
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Cursor Location
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Selected PIREP
PIREP Detail
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
1. While viewing a WX Data Link Map page of the WX page group, press the
MENU key to display the Page Menu Options. The cursor flashes on the
Foreword
“Weather Setup” option. Press ENT.
2. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight the PIREPS Viewing Range value.
3. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
System
Sec 1
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
4. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the Navigation Map page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Sec 2
PFD
Viewing Textual AIREPs/PIREPs
Textual AIREPs/PIREPs can be viewed by selecting an AIREP/PIREP on the
Sec 3
MFD
Map or Weather (WX) pages.
1. While viewing a Map or Weather page, Use the small and large MFD knobs to
move the cursor to highlight an airport with an AIREP/PIREP. Press ENT.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
2. The Waypoint Information page for that airport will now be shown. Press the
WX soft key to view weather information for the waypoint.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
4.9.12 METARs
NOTE: Atmospheric pressure reported for METARs is given in hectopascals
Foreword
about the temperature, dew point, wind, precipitation, cloud cover, cloud
MFD
heights, visibility, and barometric pressure. They can also contain information
on precipitation amounts, lightning, and other critical data. METARs are shown
Avoidance
Cursor Location
Additional
Features
IFR METAR
Sec 5
VFR METAR
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Foreword
(WX) pages.
1. While viewing a Map or Weather page, Use the small and large MFD knobs to
move the cursor to highlight an airport with a METAR flag. Press ENT.
System
Sec 1
2. The Waypoint Information page for that airport will now be shown. Press the
WX soft key to view weather information for the waypoint.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
at and below that value METAR weather products will be shown on the selected
MFD Wx Data Link Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off is selected, METARs will
not be shown. Where a value (such as 150 NM) is selected, METAR data will be
System
Sec 1
shown at map ranges of the selected value (150 NM) and lower.
1. While viewing a WX Data Link Map page of the WX page group, press the
MENU key to display the Page Menu Options. Turn the large MFD knob to
Sec 2
PFD
3. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
4. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
the WX page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
and at selected altitudes. Altitudes can be selected in 3000 foot increments from
the surface up to 42,000 feet MSL. Pressing the WX Alt Dn or WX Alt Up soft
keys steps down or up in 3,000 foot increments.
System
Sec 1
Selected Altitude
Product Age
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Present Position
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Winds Aloft Symbol
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Winds Aloft Altitude Soft Keys
Figure 4-116 GFDS Weather - Winds Aloft
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
range where at and below that value Winds Aloft weather products will appear
on the selected MFD Wx Data Link Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off is selected,
Winds Aloft will not be shown. Where 150 NM is selected, Winds Aloft data will
System
Sec 1
3. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
4. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
the WX page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
short term restrictions. The update rate is approximately every 20 minutes.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
TFR Detail
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Select TFR Symbol
To View Details
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 4-118 GFDS Weather - TFRs
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
The Temporary Flight Restriction (TFR) viewing range option selects
whether TFR information is shown on the GFDS Weather Map. TFR information
Symbols
will be shown at and below the selected map range. When Off is selected, the
Sec 7
information will not be shown. For the value (such as 500 NM) selected, TFR
information will be shown at map ranges of that value (500 NM), and lower.
Glossary
Sec 8
1. While viewing a GFDS Weather Map page of the WX page group, turn the large
MFD knob to highlight the TFR Data Viewing Range option.
2. Turn the small MFD knob to change the highlighted value.
Appendix A
pages.
1. While viewing a GFDS Weather page, Use the small and large MFD knobs to
move the cursor to highlight a TFR symbol (yellow circle). Press ENT.
System
Sec 1
a Doppler radar system that has greatly improved the detection of meteorological
Sec 5
124 nautical miles. The ADS-B/FIS-B receiver sends the FIS-B information to
the GDU 620.
NOTE: The ADS-B/FIS-B receiver will send all FIS-B weather and
Symbols
Sec 7
of the FIS-B data as “received” and “current” even though some of the
Sec 8
Foreword
but not all, causes of abnormal displayed information include:
• Ground Clutter
• Strobes and spurious radar data
System
Sec 1
• Sun strobes, when the radar antenna points directly at the sun
• Military aircraft deploy metallic dust which can cause alterations in radar scans
• Interference from buildings or mountains, which may cause shadows
• Scheduled maintenance may put a radar off-line
Sec 2
PFD
4.10.2 NEXRAD Limitations
Certain limitations exist regarding the NEXRAD radar displays. Some, but
not all, are listed for the user’s awareness:
Sec 3
MFD
• The Regional NEXRAD “pixels” are 1.5 minutes (1.5 nautical miles
= 2.78 km) wide by 1 minute (1 nautical miles = 1.852 km) tall. The
CONUS NEXRAD “pixels” are 7.5 minutes (7.5 nautical miles = 13.89
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
km) wide by 5 minutes (5 nautical miles = 9.26 km) wide. Above 60
degrees of latitude the Regional NEXRAD “pixels” are 3 minutes/nautical
miles. CONUS NEXRAD is not available above 60 degrees of latitude.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
The intensity level reflected by the pixel will be the highest level sampled
within the area covered by each pixel.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
NOTE: Where it is noted that NOTAM data is available, it is possible only
a subset of the data is available and that more NOTAM reports may arrive
Symbols
wide range of signals (from very weak to very strong). So, a more convenient
number for calculations and comparison, a decibel (or logarithmic) scale (dBZ),
is used. The dBZ values increase as the strength of the signal returned to the
radar increases.
Index
4.10.4 NEXRAD
When enabled, NEXRAD weather information is shown. Composite data
Foreword
from all of the NEXRAD radar sites in the United States is shown. This data is
composed of the maximum reflectivity from the individual radar sweeps. The
display of the information is color-coded to indicate the weather level severity.
System
Regional and/or CONUS NEXRAD imagery displayed on the MAP and FIS-B
Weather Pages of the affected products is an indicator of poor FIS-B reception.
Avoidance
Affected Areas
Hazard
Sec 4
Any area in the continental United States (CONUS) or Alaska where the
distance from ADS-B ground stations, or the combined effect of distance and
low altitude, is sufficiently great may cause poor reception. A good source of
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Foreword
1. While viewing the FIS-B Weather Map 1, 2, or 3 of the Wx page group, press
the MENU key. With “Weather Setup” highlighted, press ENT.
2. With the “Map Orientation” option active, turn the small MFD knob to change
System
Sec 1
the highlighted value.
Sec 2
PFD
Figure 4-120 Weather Page Map Orientation
Sec 3
MFD
3. Press ENT to accept the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
4. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the Navigation Map page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
4.10.5.2 NEXRAD Data Viewing Range
The NEXRAD Viewing Range option allows you to select the map range
Additional
where at and below the selected value NEXRAD weather products will be shown
Features
Sec 5
on the selected MFD FIS-B Weather Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off is selected,
NEXRAD weather data will not be shown. Where a value (such as 250 NM) is
selected, NEXRAD data will be shown at map ranges of that value (250 NM)
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
and lower.
1. While viewing a FIS-B Weather Map page of the WX page group, press the
MENU key to display the Page Menu Options. The cursor flashes on the
Symbols
Sec 7
3. Press ENT to accept the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
4. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
Appendix A
the Navigation Map page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Index
MENU key to display the Page Menu Options. The cursor flashes on the
“Weather Setup” option. Press ENT.
2. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight the NEXRAD Legend value.
Glossary
Sec 8
3. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight Off or On. Press ENT to accept the
displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
Appendix A
4. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the Navigation Map page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Index
Foreword
1. While viewing the FIS-B weather page, press the Menu key.
2. With the Weather Setup selection highlighted, press ENT.
System
Sec 1
3. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight the NEXRAD Data Viewing Range Source
option.
4. Turn the small MFD knob to select the desired Source option and press ENT.
Sec 2
PFD
Continental US NEXRAD (CONUS)
The Display CONUS NEXRAD selection shows NEXRAD radar information
for the entire continental United States. CONUS NEXRAD data is updated every
Sec 3
MFD
15 minutes.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Regional NEXRAD
The Regional NEXRAD selection shows available regional NEXRAD radar
Foreword
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Combined NEXRAD
Regional NEXRAD data and CONUS NEXRAD data are shown together. The
Foreword
two types of NEXRAD are separated by a white stippled border. This boundary
is updated whenever new Regional or CONUS NEXRAD data is received. The
radius of the boundary is fixed at 150 NM.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
CONUS Data Area
Regional Boundary
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Figure 4-124 FIS-B Combined NEXRAD
4.10.5.5 SIGMETs and AIRMETs
Symbols
Sec 7
Cursor Location
Foreword
Turbulence Line
System
Sec 1
shown on the selected MFD FIS-B Weather Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off
is selected, SIGMET/AIRMET will not be shown. For a value selected (such as,
150 NM), SIGMET/AIRMET data will be shown at map ranges of that value
Symbols
Sec 7
value.
3. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
Index
4. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the Navigation Map page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Foreword
line on the Map or Weather (WX) pages.
1. While viewing a Map or Weather page, Use the small and large MFD knobs to
move the cursor to highlight a SIGMET/AIRMET line. Press ENT.
System
Sec 1
2. The Waypoint Information page for that line will now be shown. Press the WX
soft key to view weather information.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
• Icing
Sec 8
• Turbulence
• IFR conditions
Appendix A
• Mountain obscuration
• Surface winds
Index
4.10.5.6 AIREP/PIREP
Pilot Weather Reports (PIREPs) provide timely weather information for a
Foreword
flight visibility, icing conditions, wind shear, and turbulence. PIREPs are issued
as either Routine (UA) or Urgent (UUA).
1. While viewing a FIS-B Weather Map page of the WX page group, press the
Sec 2
PFD
MENU key to display the Page Menu Options. The cursor flashes on the
“Weather Setup” option. Press ENT.
2. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight the PIREPS Viewing Range value.
Sec 3
MFD
3. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
4. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the Navigation Map page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Additional
Product Age
Features
Sec 5
Selected PIREP
PIREP Detail
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
Map or Weather (WX) pages.
1. While viewing a Map or Weather page, Use the small and large MFD knobs to
move the cursor to highlight a AIREP/PIREP. Press ENT.
System
Sec 1
2. Press ENT or the small MFD knob to return to the Weather page.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Figure 4-128 FIS-B AIREPs/PIREPs Detail and Legend
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
4.10.5.7 METARs
NOTE: Atmospheric pressure reported for METARs is given in hectopascals
Foreword
METARs are updated hourly and are considered current. METARs typically
contain information about the temperature, dew point, wind, precipitation,
cloud cover, cloud heights, visibility, and barometric pressure. They can also
Sec 3
MFD
Cursor Location
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
The METAR Viewing Range option allows you to select the map range where
at and below that value METAR weather products will be shown on the selected
MFD FIS-B Weather Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off is selected, METARs will
Index
not be shown. For a value (such as 150 NM) selected, METAR data will be
shown at map ranges of that value (150 NM), and lower.
1. While viewing a FIS-B Weather Map page of the WX page group, press the
MENU key to display the Page Menu Options. The cursor flashes on the
Foreword
“Weather Setup” option. Press ENT.
2. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight the METAR Data Viewing Range value.
3. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
System
Sec 1
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
4. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the Navigation Map page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Sec 2
PFD
Viewing Textual METARs
Textual METARs can be viewed by selecting an airport on the Map or Weather
Sec 3
MFD
(WX) pages.
1. While viewing a Map or Weather page, Use the small and large MFD knobs to
move the cursor to highlight an airport with a METAR flag. Press ENT.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
2. The Waypoint Information page for that airport will now be shown. Press the
WX soft key to view weather information for the waypoint.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
and at selected altitudes. Altitudes can be selected in 3000 foot increments from
the surface up to 42,000 feet MSL by pressing the WX Alt Dn or WX Alt Up
soft keys.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
on the selected MFD FIS-B Weather Map page (1, 2, or 3). When Off is selected,
Winds Aloft will not be shown. For the value (such as 150 NM) selected, Winds
Avoidance
Aloft data will be shown at map ranges of that value (such as 150 NM), and
Hazard
Sec 4
lower.
1. While viewing a FIS-B Weather Map page of the WX page group, press the
Additional
Features
MENU key to display the Page Menu Options. The cursor flashes on the
Sec 5
value.
3. Turn the small MFD knob to highlight the desired value. Press ENT to accept
the displayed value. The next option will be highlighted.
Symbols
Sec 7
4. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing and return to
the Navigation Map page or turn the large MFD knob to the next option.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
short term restrictions.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Select TFR Outline
Avoidance
To View Details
Hazard
Sec 4
TFR Detail
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 4-132 FIS-B Weather - TFRs
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
The Temporary Flight Restriction (TFR) viewing range option selects
whether TFR information is shown on the FIS-B Weather Map. TFR information
will be shown at and below the selected map range. When Off is selected, the
Symbols
Sec 7
information will not be shown. For the value (such as 500 NM) selected, TFR
information will be shown at map ranges of that value (500 NM), and lower.
Glossary
1. While viewing a FIS-B Weather Map page of the WX page group, turn the large
Sec 8
pages.
1. While viewing a Weather page, Use the small and large MFD knobs to move
the cursor to highlight a TFR outline (yellow circle). Press ENT.
System
Sec 1
2. A summary of the TFR will be shown and the first TFR will be highlighted. In
the case of multiple TFRs, turn the small or large MFD knobs to highlight the
desired TFR.
Sec 2
PFD
3. Press the VIEW TEXT soft key to view the full TFR text.
4. Press ENT to return to the Weather page.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
represent the rate at which weather data is updated or new content is received by
Annun.
Sec 6
(Minutes)
CONUS NEXRAD 60
SIGMETs / AIRMETs 60
Glossary
Sec 8
METARs 90
Winds Aloft 90
Appendix A
PIREPS 90
NOTAMs/TFRs 60
Table 4-29 FIS-B Weather Data Timing
Index
4.11 Stormscope
Foreword
NOTE: Refer to the WX-500 Pilot’s Guide for a detailed description of the
WX-500 StormScope.
System
Sec 1
avoidance system that detects electrical discharges associated with thunderstorms
within a 200 NM radius of the aircraft. StormScope measures relative bearing
and distance of thunderstorm-related electrical activity and reports the
Sec 2
PFD
information to the display. Interfaces are currently only available for the WX-
500 StormScope System.
For lightning display interpretation, study the examples in the WX-500
Sec 3
MFD
Pilot’s Guide that are designed to help you relate the cell or strike patterns shown
on the display to the size and location of thunderstorms that may be near your
aircraft.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Less than 60
System
Sec 1
Mode
The Mode selection allows you to select the display of storm cells or strikes.
Sec 3
MFD
from sifting through a screen full of discharge points and helps to better
Hazard
Sec 4
View
Additional
Features
Sec 5
1. While viewing the Weather StormScope page, press the Clear key to clear
lightning strikes.
Glossary
2. Lightning strikes will be cleared from the display and the Rate value will be
Sec 8
reset.
NOTE: When Heading is not available (N/A), the pilot must clear the strikes
Appendix A
Foreword
NOTE: The availability of SafeTaxi, ChartView, or FliteCharts in electronic
form may not preclude the requirement to carry paper charts aboard the
aircraft. See the AFMS for more information.
System
Sec 1
NOTE: ChartView is an optional feature that requires enablement by a
Garmin dealer.
Sec 2
PFD
• ChartView and FliteCharts electronic charts
• SafeTaxi diagrams
Sec 3
MFD
• Sirius XM Satellite Radio entertainment
• XM WX Satellite Weather (covered in Section 4.7)
Avoidance
• Traffic (covered in Sections 4.5 and 4.6)
Hazard
Sec 4
• Synthetic Vision Technology (SVT)
The optional ChartView and FliteCharts provide on-board electronic terminal
Additional
Features
Sec 5
procedures charts. Electronic charts offer the convenience of rapid access to
essential information. Either ChartView or FliteCharts may be configured in the
system.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
SafeTaxi diagrams provide detailed taxiway, runway, and ramp information
at more than 700 airports in the United States. By decreasing the range on an
airport that has a SafeTaxi diagram available, a close up view of the airport layout
Symbols
Sec 7
can be seen.
The optional Sirius XM Satellite Radio entertainment audio feature of the
GDL 69A Data Link Receiver handles more than 170 channels of music, news,
Glossary
and sports. Sirius XM Satellite Radio offers more entertainment choices and
Sec 8
display graphic weather data overlaid on the MFD Nav Map and Weather Data
Link pages.
The Traffic Map Page shows surrounding TAS or TIS traffic data in relation to
Index
the aircraft’s current position and altitude. The Traffic option is designed to assist
in detection and avoidance of other aircraft.
When the Chart feature is available, charts will be shown on the third page
of the Flight Plan page group. The Chart page will default to the nearest airport
if no flight plan or destination airport is present. While you are on the ground,
Sec 2
PFD
the displayed charts will default to the current airport location regardless of
flight plan.
Both ChartView and FliteCharts may be geo-referenced. The icon will have
Sec 3
MFD
course guidance for the loaded route or procedure shown on the Flight Plan
page. The term “Chart Unavailable” means that the chart cannot be viewed
on the Chart page due to either a chart not being published, or an error
Symbols
in the chart database, but does not preclude its availability or inclusion of
Sec 7
the procedure in the Flight Plan or Procedures portion of the system. The
absence of a chart for a particular Departure, Arrival, or Approach does
not preclude its availability or inclusion in the Flight Plan. The absence of
Glossary
a particular Departure, Arrival, or Approach under the Flight Plan does not
Sec 8
NOTE: Do not use SafeTaxi or Chartview functions as the basis for ground
Appendix A
NOTE: The chart for the destination airport or loaded approach will
automatically be selected.
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 5-1 ChartView Chart Page Figure 5-2 FliteChart Chart Page
1. Turn the large MFD knob to the Flight Plan (FPL) page group.
2. Turn the small MFD knob to the Chart page.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
5.1.1 ChartView (Optional)
ChartView resembles the paper version of Jeppesen terminal procedures
Symbols
charts. The charts are displayed in full color with high-resolution. The MFD
Sec 7
depiction shows the aircraft position on the moving map in the plan view of
approach charts and on airport diagrams.
Glossary
• Arrivals (STAR)
• Departure Procedures (DP)
• Approaches
Index
• Airport Diagrams
• Chart NOTAMs
190-00601-02 Rev. J Garmin G500/G600 Pilot’s Guide 5-3
Cover TOC
during a period that extends from the cycle expiration date to the disables date.
ChartView is disabled 70 days after the expiration date and is no longer available
for viewing upon reaching the disable date. When turning on the GDU 620, the
System
Sec 1
Power-up Page indicates any of nine different possible criteria for ChartView
availability. See the table below for the various ChartView Power-up Page
displays and the definition of each.
Sec 2
PFD
5.1.2 FliteCharts
FliteCharts resemble the paper version of FAA-published terminal procedures
charts. FliteChart data may also be provided by sources other than the FAA. The
Sec 3
MFD
charts are displayed with high-resolution and in color for applicable charts. The
MFD FliteCharts depiction shows the aircraft position on the moving map in the
Avoidance
• Arrivals (STAR)
Features
Sec 5
a period that extends from the cycle expiration date to the disables date.
FliteCharts is disabled 180 days after the expiration date and are no longer
available for viewing upon reaching the disables date. When turning on the
Glossary
GDU 620, the Power-up page indicates any of five different possible criteria for
Sec 8
chart availability. These indications are whether the databases are not configured,
not available, current, out of date, or disabled. See table 5-1 for the various
Appendix A
Foreword
Chart Database Type
Select the DBASE soft key for scrolling through the database information.
Scroll through the database with the MFD knob or ENT key.
System
Sec 1
1. Turn the large MFD knob to select AUX.
2. Press the DB ACTV key to view the databases.
Sec 2
3. Press the small MFD knob and then turn the small or large MFD knobs to
PFD
highlight Chart Type. The field will show Not Available, ChartView, or FliteCharts.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Figure 5-3 ChartView Database Information
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Figure 5-4 FliteChart Database Information
Chart Coverage
Symbols
The chart databases cover the area that was selecting during the download
Sec 7
process. FliteCharts will note the region covered by the installed chart database;
ChartView does not.
Glossary
Chart Currency
Sec 8
The date currency of the installed chart databases are shown both during
power-up and on the AUX - System Status page.
Index
Database is active.
Sec 2
PFD
displayed at the bottom of the page: “Check local rules for database effective times.”
[2] ChartView does not have “Effective” dates.
Table 5-1 Power-up Page Annunciations and Definitions
Foreword
NOTE: When the charts database synchronizes with another LRU, and
Chart Streaming is not available, a message banner at the bottom of the
Chart page displays “Getting newer charts.” This process can take several
minutes.
System
Sec 1
The G500/G600 will only allow the pilot to select the chart type in normal
mode if it is configured for ChartView. When in-air, the pilot cannot select the
field to change the chart source, and a small message is displayed underneath the
Sec 2
PFD
Chart Type line that reads “Chart Type can only be changed when on ground”.
The ability to select a chart type is absent from normal mode if configured for
FliteCharts.
Sec 3
MFD
5.1.4.1 Selecting FliteCharts or ChartView
When configured during installation and when both chart types are available,
you can select which chart type will be used. Only one chart type can be used
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
at a time.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 5-5 Chart NOTAM
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
1. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight the Chart Type sections.
2. Turn the small MFD knob to select ChartView or FliteCharts.
3. Press the ENT key to save the selected value.
Symbols
Sec 7
4. Changing chart type requires a restart of the unit. With OK selected, press the
ENT key to restart the unit and change to the selected chart type.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
of the nearest airport (NRST), or your most recently selected airports (RECENT).
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
2. Turn the small MFD knob counterclockwise to show FPL, NRST, or RECENT.
3. Turn the large MFD knob to select the desired identifier and then press ENT.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
1. While viewing the Chart page of the FPL page group, press the SELECT soft key
to change the airport.
Foreword
2. Use the small MFD knob to change the character.
3. Use the large MFD knob to move the cursor to highlight a character.
System
4. Press ENT to accept the selected airport.
Sec 1
5.1.4.4 Chart Auto-Selection
The Chart page will automatically select a chart to display when the page is
Sec 2
PFD
opened.
NOTE: The chart for the destination airport or loaded approach will
automatically be selected.
Sec 3
MFD
• While on the ground, the nearest airport diagram will be displayed.
• If an approach is loaded in the selected GPS navigator, the chart for that
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
approach will be displayed. In some cases, the pilot may be prompted to
select the correct chart from a list of possible matches.
Additional
• If an approach is not loaded, the airport diagram for the destination
Features
Sec 5
airport will be displayed.
• If no destination airport exists, the nearest airport diagram will be
displayed.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
NOTE: Automatic chart selection only occurs when the Chart page is
opened. For example, if a new approach is loaded while the Chart page is
open, a different MFD page must be selected and the Chart page re-opened
Symbols
Sec 7
When the pilot has manually selected a chart to display, a different chart will
Glossary
1. While viewing the Chart page of the FPL page group, press the SELECT soft key
to activate chart selection.
Index
2. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight the field to the right of the airport
identifier.
Figure 5-9 Activate Chart Selection for the Current Airport (ChartView)
4. Press ENT to accept and view the selected chart.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Figure 5-10 Selected Chart for the Current Airport (ChartView)
Additional
5.1.5 Using Charts
Features
Sec 5
More detail on the displayed chart can be viewed by zooming in with the
Range keys and moving the chart around with pan mode. The Detail soft key
& Alerts
Annun.
allows access to more details for the currently displayed chart.
Sec 6
5.1.5.1 Chart Zooming and Panning
Chart zooming and Panning allows viewing charts closer to examine details.
Symbols
Sec 7
1. While viewing the Chart page of the FPL page group, press the RNG (Range)
keys to zoom in and out.
2. After zooming in, you may only see part of the chart. Press the small MFD knob
Additional
Features
Sec 5
to enter Pan mode and activate scroll bars on the edges of the chart. Turn the
large and small MFD knobs to move around the chart.
3. Press the small MFD knob to cancel the scroll bars and exit panning.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
NOTE: The chart for the destination airport or loaded approach will
automatically be selected.
NOTE: Chart details are only available for instrument approach procedure
System
charts. Chart details are not available for airport diagrams or SID/STAR
Sec 1
charts.
1. Press the Detail key to view detailed views of the current chart. The Detail key
Sec 2
PFD
is only available with ChartView.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
3. Press the Back key to return to the view of the full chart.
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
the Set Minimums item highlighted, press ENT.
2. With the Minimums Source highlighted, select the Altitude Minimums Alerter
source with small MFD knob.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Figure 5-14 Minimums Source Selection
3. Turn the large MFD knob to highlight the Altitude Minimums value. Turn the
Sec 3
MFD
large and small MFD knobs to change the Altitude Minimums value and then
press ENT to activate the selected value.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 5-15 Minimums Altitude Selection
Alerting is inhibited while the aircraft is on the ground and until the aircraft
reaches 150 feet above the MDA. The Minimum altitude will be available in the
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Altitude Alerter.
In dual installations, the minimums alerting altitude value may be set from
Symbols
NOTE: If you highlight the Minimums Altitude field on the FPL page and
press the CLR key, it will turn the minimums functionality off.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
NOTAM soft key will be available. Press the NOTAM soft key to view the
NOTAM or select View NOTAMs from the Chart Options menu.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
viewing. The Day View offers a better presentation in a bright environment. The
Night View gives a better presentation for viewing in a dark environment. .
When AUTO is selected, it allows the user to set a threshold for the transition
System
Sec 1
between the Day and Night color schemes.
Sec 2
PFD
Figure 5-17 Chart Color Scheme Auto Selection and Aux Display Brightness
The threshold is compared to the Display Brightness Level that is displayed
Sec 3
on the Aux System Setup page. If the color scheme percentage on the Chart
MFD
Setup page is less than the display brightness percentage selected on the Aux
System Setup page, then the Chart AUTO Color Scheme will draw the chart as
Avoidance
though the NIGHT scheme were selected. Otherwise, the AUTO scheme will
Hazard
Sec 4
draw the chart as though the DAY scheme were selected.
1. In the FPL page group, turn the small MFD knob to reach the Chart page.
Additional
Features
2. Press MENU to display the Options menu.
Sec 5
3. Press ENT to go to Chart Setup. The Color Scheme option will be highlighted.
4. Turn the small MFD knob to select Day - AUTO - Night.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
5. If Auto is selected, turn the large MFD knob CW to the percentage value and
turn the small MFD knob to change the value.
6. Press the small MFD knob or the ENT key to save the selected value and return
Symbols
Sec 7
5.2 SafeTaxi
Foreword
SafeTaxi is an enhanced feature that gives greater map detail when zooming
in on airports at close range. The airport display on the map reveals runways
with numbers, taxiways with identifying letters/numbers, airport Hot Spots,
and airport landmarks including ramps, buildings, control towers, and other
System
Sec 1
prominent features. Resolution is greater at lower map ranges. When the aircraft
location is within the screen boundary, including within SafeTaxi ranges, an
aircraft symbol is shown on any of the navigation map views for enhanced
Sec 2
position awareness.
PFD
awareness confusion or runway incursions happen most often. Hot Spots are
defined with a magenta circle or outline around the region of possible confusion.
Avoidance
Selected Hot
Hazard
Sec 4
Taxiway
Identification
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Hot Spot
Outline
Aircraft
Symbols
position
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Foreword
airport layout within the maximum configured range. The following is a list of
pages where the SafeTaxi feature can be seen:
• Navigation Map Page • NDB Information Page
System
Sec 1
• Weather Datalink Page • VOR Information Page
• Airport Information Page • User Waypoint Information Page
Sec 2
• Intersection Information Page
PFD
During ground operations the aircraft’s position is displayed in reference to
taxiways, runways, and airport features. When panning over the airport, features
Sec 3
MFD
such as runway holding lines and taxiways are shown.
5.2.1.1 Decluttering
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
The DCLTR soft key (declutter) label advances to DCLTR-1, DCLTR -2, and
DCLTR-3 each time the soft key is selected for easy recognition of decluttering
level. Selecting the DCLTR soft key removes the taxiway markings and airport
Additional
Features
feature labels. Selecting the DCLTR-1 soft key removes VOR station ID, the VOR
Sec 5
symbol, and intersection names if within the airport plan view. Selecting the
DCLTR-2 soft key removes the airport runway layout, unless the airport in view
is part of an active route structure. Pressing the DCLTR-3 soft key cycles back
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
to the original map detail. With Auto-Zoom enabled, the map will automatically
zoom to 1 NM and DCLTR-0 upon landing so SafeTaxi can be viewed. Refer to
Map Declutter Levels in the Navigation Map Section.
Symbols
Sec 7
when selected.
Sec 8
1. While viewing the Hot Spot area on the Navigation Map page, press the small
MFD knob to activate the cursor.
Appendix A
2. Turn the MFD knobs to move the cursor on the Hot Spot border or into the Hot
Spot area and then press the ENT key.
Index
Hot Spot
Information
Border
Figure 5-19 SafeTaxi Hot Spot Information
3. An information window will be shown on the MFD. After viewing, press the
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
small MFD knob, CLR, or ENT keys to remove the information window. Press
the small MFD knob again to cancel the cursor.
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
for use after the expiration date. When turning on the GDU 620, the Power-up
Page indicates whether the databases are current, out of date, or not available.
The Power-up Page shows the SafeTaxi database is current when the “SafeTaxi
System
Sec 1
Expires” date is shown in white. When the SafeTaxi cycle has expired, the
“SafeTaxi Expires” date appears in yellow. The message “SafeTaxi: N/A” appears
in white if no SafeTaxi data is available on the database card.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
SafeTaxi Database Status
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Figure 5-20 Power-up Page, SafeTaxi Database
The SafeTaxi Region, Version, Cycle, Effective date and Expires date of the
Additional
Features
Sec 5
database cycle can also be found on the AUX - System Status page. SafeTaxi
information appears in white and yellow text. The EFFECTIVE date appears in
white when data is current and in yellow when the current date is before the
& Alerts
Annun.
effective date. The EXPIRES date appears in white when data is current and in
Sec 6
yellow when expired. SafeTaxi REGION NOT AVAILABLE appears in white if
SafeTaxi data is not available on the database card. Expired SafeTaxi data is never
disabled.
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Data Link Receiver is available for the pilot’s and passengers’ enjoyment. The
GDL 69A can receive Sirius XM Satellite Radio entertainment services at any
altitude throughout the Continental U.S. Entertainment audio is not available
Sec 2
PFD
one or two coded IDs, depending on the equipment. Either the Audio Radio ID
or the Data Radio ID, or both, must be provided to Sirius XM Satellite Radio to
activate the entertainment subscription. The Sirius XM Satellite Radio Activation
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
sold separately. It is not required to activate both the entertainment and weather
service subscriptions with the GDL 69A. Either or both services can be activated.
Sirius XM Satellite Radio uses one or both of the coded IDs to send an activation
Glossary
signal that, when received by the GDL 69A, allows it to play entertainment
Sec 8
programming.
These IDs are located:
Appendix A
located.
NOTE: The LOCK soft key on the XM Information Page (Auxiliary Page
Group) is used to save GDL 69A activation data when the Sirius XM
Foreword
Satellite Radio services are initially set up. It is not used during normal
Sirius XM Satellite Radio operation, but there should be no adverse effects
if inadvertently selected during flight. Refer to the GDL 69/69A Sirius XM
Satellite Radio Activation Instructions (190-00355-04, Rev G, or later) for
System
Sec 1
further information.
Sec 2
PFD
Page and a yellow Activation Required message is displayed in the center of
the Weather Data Link Page (Map Page Group). The Service Class refers to the
groupings of weather products available for subscription.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
XM Satellite radios, service class, and products when the GDL 69/69A is installed
and the Sirius XM Satellite Radio service is activated. The Data and Audio radios
have separate Identification Numbers. The Service Class determines the features
System
Sec 1
that are available. Products that are not part of the subscription are displayed in
gray. Products that are part of the active subscription, but are waiting to receive
data are white. Products that are part of the active subscription and have data
Sec 2
are green.
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
1. In the AUX page group, turn the small MFD knob to display XM Information.
2. The LOCK soft key is used to “lock” your Sirius XM Satellite Radio subscription
Appendix A
activation. This is only used for the initial subscription or to make a change.
NOTE: Refer to the GDL 69/69A Sirius XM Satellite Radio Activation
Instructions (190-00355-04, Rev G, or later) for further information.
Index
Foreword
when activated in the optional installation of the GDL 69A. The GDU 620 serves
as the display and control head for your remotely mounted GDL 69A. Sirius XM
Satellite Radio allows you to enjoy a variety of radio programming over long
System
Sec 1
distances without having to constantly search for new stations. Based on signal
from satellites, coverage far exceeds land-based transmissions. When enabled,
the Sirius XM Satellite Radio audio entertainment is accessible in Aux page
group.
Sec 2
PFD
The information on the Sirius XM Satellite Radio display is composed of
four areas: the Active Channel, Available Channels, Category of the highlighted
channel, and the Volume setting. The Active Channel window shows the Channel
Sec 3
MFD
Name and Number, Artist, Song Title, and Category.
1. Turn the large MFD knob to Aux Mode.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
2. Turn the small MFD knob to the XM Radio page.
Additional
Active Channel
Features
Sec 5
Window
& Alerts
Available Channel
Annun.
Sec 6
Window Channel Scroll Bar
Selected Channel
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Page Name
Soft Keys
Appendix A
Categories of channels, such as Jazz, Rock, or News, can be selected to list the
available channels for a type of music or other contents.
1. While viewing the XM Radio page of the AUX page group, press the CATGRY
System
Sec 1
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
3. Press ENT to display the list of channels for the highlighted category in the
Channels window.
4. Press the small MFD knob to cancel selection or to end editing.
Glossary
Sec 8
OR
1. Press CATGRY and then the CAT + or CAT – soft keys to increment up or
Appendix A
3. Press ENT to save the selection or press the small MFD knob to cancel
selection.
Foreword
category.
Active Channel Number
Artist Name
System
Category
Sec 1
Active Channel Name
Song Title
Sec 2
PFD
New Selected Channel
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Figure 5-25 XM Channel Selection
1. While viewing the XM Radio page of the AUX page group, press the small MFD
knob and then turn the small MFD knob to select the desired channel.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
2. Press ENT to make the highlighted channel the Active Channel.
The listed title may end before the radio begins playing the current Active
Sec 7
Channel material.
OR
4. Press CHNL and then the CH + or CH – soft keys to increment up or down one
Appendix A
6. Press ENT to save the selection or press the small MFD knob to cancel
selection.
190-00601-02 Rev. J Garmin G500/G600 Pilot’s Guide 5-27
Cover TOC
the audio.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
2. Press the VOL + or VOL – soft keys, or turn the small MFD knob, to adjust the
radio volume.
Symbols
Sec 7
4. Press MUTE again or the VOL + or VOL – soft keys to unmute the radio
volume.
Index
Foreword
preset position for easy later recall. A delay of several seconds can occur when
setting or recalling a preset.
System
Sec 1
Active Channel
Number and Name
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Active Channel
and Song Title
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Feature Tip
Sec 5
Preset Soft Keys
Figure 5-28 XM Radio Presets
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Setting a Preset
1. While viewing the XM Radio page of the AUX page group, you may set a preset
for the Active Channel. Press the PRESETS soft key.
Symbols
Sec 7
Recalling a Preset
1. While viewing the XM Radio page of the AUX page group, press the PRESETS
Appendix A
soft key.
2. Press the preset soft key for the desired stored channel, such as PS1.
3. Press the MORE soft key to display the next series of presets.
Index
Some quick troubleshooting steps listed below can be performed to find the
possible cause of a failure.
• Ensure the owner/operator of the aircraft in which the Data Link Receiver is
System
Sec 1
• Perform a quick check of the circuit breakers to ensure that power is applied
PFD
System Status Page for Data Link Receiver (GDL 69/69A) status, serial number,
and software version number. If a failure has been detected in the GDL 69/69A
the status will be marked with a red “X.”
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
1. Turn the large MFD knob to select the AUX Page Group.
2. Turn the small MFD knob to select the System Status Page (the last page in the
AUX Page Group).
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
GDL 69 Status OK
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
LRU Selection
Index
Foreword
The G500/G600 is able to interface to certain autopilot systems to provide the
functions described in this section. Please refer to your particular Airplane Flight
Manual and autopilot documentation for specific information and operating
instructions.
System
Sec 1
5.4.1 GAD 43 Attitude
The GAD 43 Adapter may Optionally provide attitude information from
a Garmin Attitude and Heading Reference System to certain autopilots. The
Sec 2
PFD
GAD 43 has the ability to disconnect the autopilot if an error in the GAD 43
output or AHRS is detected. This disconnect mechanism must be tested prior to
each flight in the following manner:
Sec 3
MFD
1. Allow all avionics to complete power up and begin normal operation.
2. Engage the autopilot while on the ground.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
3. Press the AP TEST soft key and verify that the autopilot disconnects normally.
CAUTION: Do not use the autopilot if the AP TEST does not disengage
Additional
the autopilot normally.
Features
Sec 5
Autopilot Disconnect
When the GDU 620 attitude monitors have detected an AHRS malfunction,
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
or the inability to actively monitor the AHRS, a “Check Attitude” annunciation
will be displayed on the PFD and the autopilot will automatically disconnect.
Symbols
Adapter.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Fly the aircraft manually and crosscheck the GDU 620 attitude indication
with the standby attitude indicator and other sources of attitude information
Foreword
5.4.2 Heading
The GDU 620 heading bug may be used in conjunction with the “Heading”
System
Sec 1
The GDU 620 altitude bug may be used to automatically capture a selected
altitude with certain autopilots. Refer to the Airplane Flight Manual and
autopilot system documentation for instructions on how to use the altitude
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
selected altitude using the ALT key on the PFD. The PFD knob window will
indicate when this function is available. The selected altitude may be alternately
armed or disarmed by pressing and holding the ALT key on the PFD bezel.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Figure 5-32 Pressing and Holding the ALT Key to Arm/Disarm the Selected Altitude
Index
Foreword
of supported autopilots. The GDU 620 provides the autopilot with the selected
course and lateral/vertical deviations. The GDU 620 acts as a switching source
between the installed navigation sources (e.g GPS/VLOC, 1-2). The navigation
System
Sec 1
source that is displayed on the HSI is sent to the autopilot. Refer to the Airplane
Flight Manual and autopilot system documentation for instructions on how to
use the autopilot navigation functions.
Sec 2
PFD
GPS Steering (GPSS) provides roll command signals calculated by the GPS
navigator to the autopilot in order to allow the aircraft to anticipate turns, make
smooth transitions when passing waypoints, and fly leg types such as Procedure
Sec 3
MFD
Turns and Holding Patterns. The autopilot must have the ability to interpret the
GPSS commands. The G500/G600 can provide GPSS information to autopilots
that have built-in support for GPSS commands, as well as to older autopilots
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
that do not have built-in support for GPSS.
Wpt 2
Flight Plan Leg 2
Additional
Features
Flight Plan Leg 1
Sec 5
Turn
Anticipation Wpt 3
Curve
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Aircraft
Present
Wpt 1 Position
Symbols
Sec 7
from a GPS navigator. The GDU 620 will send the GPSS commands from the
displayed GPS source to the autopilot. For example, if GPS 1 is displayed on the
HSI, the GPSS commands from GPS 1 will be sent to the autopilot. Refer to the
Appendix A
GPSS support, the GDU 620 can convert the GPSS commands into a heading
signal. When GPSS mode is turned on, the autopilot heading mode will follow
the GPSS commands instead of the heading bug. Refer to the Airplane Flight
System
Manual and autopilot system documentation for instructions on how to use the
Sec 1
installation uses the HDG key on the PFD, the PFD knob window will display
the GPSS/HDG mode options.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
outline and a crossed-out heading bug appears in the PFD Knob Mode Indicator,
indicating that the autopilot is not coupled to the heading bug. The bug is still
controllable and may still be used by the pilot for reference. GPSS is annunciated
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
in the lower left portion of the PFD. The GPSS mode annunciation depends on
the location of the NAV STATUS information, as shown in the following figure.
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
The G500/G600 system limits the distance the flight director pitch commands
may deviate from the aircraft attitude icon. In the event that the pitch command
Foreword
provided by the autopilot flight director is greater than the distance allowed by
the G500/G600, the command bars will be displayed at the maximum distance
allowed by the G500/G600. As the aircraft pitch changes to satisfy the command
System
bars, the bars will continue to be displayed at the maximum distance from the
Sec 1
aircraft attitude icon until the aircraft pitch deviation is within the command
display limit.
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
SVT Off SVT On
Sec 5
Figure 5-36 Flight Director Bars Showing Aircraft Pitch
Sec 6
certain autopilots. Refer to the Airplane Flight Manual and autopilot system
documentation for instructions on how to use the vertical speed mode, if
available.
Symbols
Sec 7
Adjust the vertical speed bug in the normal manner when using the
vertical speed mode interface. Some autopilot installations support engaging/
Glossary
disengaging the vertical speed mode using the VS key on the PFD. The PFD
Sec 8
knob window will indicate when this function is available. The vertical speed
mode may be alternately engaged or disengaged by pressing and holding the VS
Appendix A
Refer to the Airplane Flight Manual and autopilot system documentation for
details on the autopilot mode annunciations.
When autopilot annunciations are displayed at the top of the PFD, the Nav
System
Sec 1
Status information will be located to the left of the HSI (NAV STATUS Style 2).
Roll Modes Autopilot Status Pitch Modes
Sec 2
PFD
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
The optional Synthetic Vision Technology (SVT) is a visual enhancement to
the G500/G600. SVT is displayed as a forward-looking display of the topography
immediately in front of the aircraft. SVT information is shown on the primary
System
flight display (PFD). The depicted imagery is derived from the aircraft attitude,
Sec 1
heading, GPS three-dimensional position, and a database of terrain, obstacles,
and other relevant features.
Sec 2
The following SVT enhancements appear on the PFD:
PFD
• Flight Path Marker • Terrain Alerting
• Horizon Heading Marks • Obstacle Alerting
Sec 3
MFD
• Traffic Display • Water
• Airport Signs • Zero-Pitch Line
Avoidance
Hazard
• Runway Display
Sec 4
SVT offers a three-dimensional view of terrain and obstacles. Terrain and/
or obstacles that pose a threat to the aircraft in flight are shaded yellow or red.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
NOTE: SVT will become disabled if the databases necessary to display
SVT are unavailable (generating a GDU DB ERR or SVT DISABLED alert) or
AHRS or GPS data is unavailable.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
edge of the display. Pressing the soft keys turn the related function on or off.
SVT functions are displayed on three levels of soft keys. The PFD soft key
leads into the PFD function soft keys, including synthetic vision. Pressing the
System
Sec 1
SYN VIS soft key enables synthetic vision and displays the SYN TERR, HRZN
HDG, and APTSIGNS soft keys. The BACK soft key returns to the previous
level of soft keys.
Sec 2
PFD
HRZN and APTSIGNS soft keys are dependent upon the state of the SYN
TERR soft key. When Synthetic Terrain is deactivated, the SYN TERR soft
key appears illuminated while the remaining SVT soft keys are unavailable for
Sec 3
MFD
discretion.
• SYN TERR soft key enables synthetic terrain depiction.
Additional
• HRZN HDG soft key enable horizon heading marks and digits.
Features
Sec 5
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Foreword
NOTE: In some instances, such as temporary loss of GPS signal, the SVT
functionality will be disabled.
To enable SVT:
System
Sec 1
1. Press the PFD soft key.
2. Press the SYN VIS soft key.
3. Press the SYN TERR soft key to view the SVT display.
Sec 2
PFD
When SVT™ is enabled, the pitch ladder will display a different pitch scale.
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Figure 5-41 Pitch Scale with SVT Enabled Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Traffic
Sec 1
Zero-Pitch Line
(ZPL) with Horizon
Heading Marks
Sec 3
MFD
Aircraft Symbol
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Synthetic Terrain
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
NOTE: SVT features are not a substitute for standard course and altitude
Symbols
Sec 7
The Flight Path Marker (FPM) is also known as a Velocity Vector. It is displayed
on the PFD at ground speeds above 30 knots. The FPM depicts approximate
projected path of the aircraft.
Appendix A
is not necessarily aligned with the terrain horizon, particularly when the terrain
is sloped or mountainous.
Foreword
headings in 30-degree increments on the Zero-Pitch Line. Horizon heading tick
marks and digits appearing on the zero-pitch line are not visible when they are
behind either the airspeed or altitude display. Horizon Heading is activated and
System
Sec 1
deactivated by pressing the HRZN HDG soft key.
Horizon Heading
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Figure 5-44 Horizon Heading
5.5.3.4 Airport Signs
Additional
Features
Airports Signs provide a visual representation of airport location and
Sec 5
identification on the synthetic terrain display. When activated, the signs appear
on the display when the aircraft is approximately 15 NM from an airport and
disappear at approximately 4.5 NM. Airport signs are shown without the
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
identifier until the aircraft is approximately 9 NM from the airport. Airport signs
are shown behind the airspeed or altitude display. Airport signs are activated and
deactivated by pressing the APT SIGNS soft key.
Symbols
Sec 7
as grass runways, are depicted in green. Hard surface runways, such as asphalt,
are depicted in gray. Your flight plan will determine how the runway is displayed
on the PFD.
System
Sec 1
Without a loaded flight plan, a runway is shown as dark gray with the
boundaries of the runway in light gray.
Sec 2
PFD
Runway
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Runway
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Runway
Index
5.5.3.6 Traffic
Traffic symbols are displayed in their approximate respective location as
Foreword
determined by the related traffic systems. TIS, TAS and ADS-B traffic are all
displayed. Traffic is displayed in three dimensions, appearing larger as they are
getting closer, and smaller when they are further away.
System
Sec 1
Traffic on PFD
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Traffic on MFD
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
5.5.3.7 Obstacles
Obstacles are represented on the synthetic display by two-dimensional tower
Foreword
or windmill symbols found on the MFD maps and charts. Obstacle symbols
appear in the perspective view with relative height above terrain and distance
from the aircraft.
System
Sec 1
Obstacle Alert
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Obstacle
Avoidance
Hazard
Unlike the MFD moving map display, obstacles on the synthetic terrain
display do not change colors based on relative altitude but will be colored to
Additional
match any SVT TERRAIN or TAWS Alert from that obstacle. Obstacles greater
Features
Sec 5
than 1000 feet below the aircraft’s altitude are not shown. Obstacles are shown
behind the airspeed and altitude displays.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
lateral image. Two dashed lines forming a V-shape in front of the aircraft symbol
on the MFD with an angle of approximately 50º represent the forward horizontal
field of view shown on the PFD.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
V-Shaped Lines
Depict PFD Field
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
of View (angle is
approx. 50°) Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Field of View
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
selection.
5. Press the small MFD knob to return to the Navigation Map Page.
Foreword
pointing to the direction to fly to correct the unusual attitude condition. The
display shows either a brown or blue band of color at the top or bottom of the
screen to represent earth or sky. This is intended to prevent losing sight of the
System
Sec 1
horizon during extreme pitch attitudes.
Two conditions that inhibit SVT and generate alerts on the PFD:
• The position of the aircraft exceeds the range of the terrain database.
Sec 2
PFD
• The terrain database is out of date using an older terrain database card.
Blue Band - Sky
Sec 3
Representation
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Full
Display
Terrain
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Representation
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
6.1 Alerts
Alerts are displayed on the MFD and are accessible via the ALERTS MFD
soft key. When a new advisory is present, the ALERTS soft key text changes to
System
Sec 1
ADVISORY and flashes until the alerts page is viewed.
The MFD ALERTS page may have two additional soft keys (TRND/ACK
and CAPTURE) which are present when interfaced to an optional ADAS+
Sec 2
PFD
Engine Trend Monitor (ETM). Pressing the TRND/ACK soft key is equivalent to
pressing the ETM Trend key for one second. Pressing the CAPTURE soft key is
equivalent to pressing the ETM Trend key for five seconds. Refer to the Airplane
Flight Manual and ADAS+ ETM documentation for the system description and
Sec 3
MFD
operating procedures.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Alert Message Description Action
ADC(1/2) ALT EC • ADC 1 or ADC 2 • Contact a Garmin dealer for
Altitude Error service.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Correction is
unavailable.
• Alert is enabled
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
and the ADC is
reporting that
altitude correction is
Symbols
Sec 7
unavailable.
ADC(1/2) • ADC 1 or ADC 2 • Contact a Garmin dealer for
SERVICE requires service. service.
Glossary
Sec 8
• AHRS 1 or AHRS 2
is using the backup
GPS source.
Sec 3
MFD
• AHRS 1 or AHRS 2 is
not receiving backup
GPS information.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
service.
ground only.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
is not receiving true service.
airspeed from the
ADC.
System
Sec 1
• Displayed heading
and attitude data is
still valid.
Sec 2
PFD
• Additional loss of
GPS data will cause
loss of heading and
Sec 3
MFD
attitude data.
AHRS CONFIG • AHRS configuration • Contact a Garmin dealer for
error. service.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
AHRS MAG DB • AHRS/GDU magnetic • Reload MAG DB.
field model database
version mismatch.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
ALT KEY INOP • The ALT key function
is disabled. ALT key
not available.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
ALT NO COMP • No data from one • Contact a Garmin dealer for
or more altitude service.
sensors.
Symbols
Sec 7
AUD SYS FAIL • Audio system failure. • Contact a Garmin dealer for
service.
Index
been ejected.
CAL LOST • Calibration data is • Contact a Garmin dealer for
lost. service.
Sec 2
PFD
charts may be
unavailable.
CHT STREAM • Chart streaming
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
is not available.
GDU reverts to the
datacard’s charts.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Foreword
receiver. service.
• ADS-B fault: 1090
receiver.
System
Sec 1
• FIS-B weather has
failed.
• GDL 88 ADS-B
Sec 2
PFD
Failure. Unable to
transmit ADS-B
messages.
Sec 3
MFD
• GDL 88 ADS-B fault.
• GDL 88 needs
Avoidance
Hazard
service.
Sec 4
• GDL 88 ADS-B is not
transmitting position.
Additional
Features
Check GPS devices.
Sec 5
• GDL 88 control panel
input fault. Check
& Alerts
Annun.
transponder mode.
Sec 6
• GDL 88 ADS-B fault.
Pressure altitude
Symbols
source inoperative.
Sec 7
• GDL 88 external
traffic system
Glossary
inoperative or
Sec 8
connection is lost.
Appendix A
Index
or connection to
GDU is lost.
• GDL 88 CSA failure.
Sec 2
PFD
• GDL 88 external
traffic system has a
low battery.
Sec 3
MFD
• GDL 88 external
traffic system in
Avoidance
than 60 seconds.
DATA LOST • Pilot stored data • Confirm the data is lost.
is lost. All pilot
Additional
Features
configurable items
return to their default
settings.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
COMPLETE complete.
• Restart required to
use new databases.
Glossary
Sec 8
Foreword
configuration error. service.
ENG SENSOR • Configuration error. • Contact a Garmin dealer for
UNIT (1/2) • Communication with service.
System
Sec 1
sensors is halted or
lost.
ETM CAPTURE • Engine Trend Monitor • Refer to the ADAS+ literature.
Sec 2
PFD
data capture.
• ADAS+ engine
monitoring system is
Sec 3
MFD
recording trend data.
ETM EXCEED • Engine Trend Monitor • Refer to the ADAS+ literature.
Avoidance
exceedance/advisory.
Hazard
Sec 4
• ADAS+ engine
monitoring system is
Additional
reporting an
Features
Sec 5
exceedance or
advisory condition.
ETM FAULT • Engine Trend Monitor • Refer to the ADAS+ literature.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
needs service.
• ADAS+ engine
monitoring system is
Symbols
Sec 7
reporting a system
fault.
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
temperatures
• Extended operation
at high temperatures
Sec 2
PFD
is not recommended
as damage to the
GDU may occur.
Sec 3
MFD
• PFD/MFD coloration
may be incorrect.
Avoidance
communication is service.
lost.
• Gyro Emulation Type • Contact a Garmin dealer for
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
fault.
• GDU AHRS Monitor • Contact a Garmin dealer for
fault. service.
Glossary
Sec 8
service.
• Yaw Rate Deviation • Contact a Garmin dealer for
fault. service.
Index
Foreword
Invalid fault. service.
• AHRS Pitch Out of • Contact a Garmin dealer for
Range fault. service.
System
Sec 1
• AHRS Attitude Invalid • Contact a Garmin dealer for
fault. service.
• AHRS A429 Heading • Contact a Garmin dealer for
Sec 2
PFD
Timeout fault. service.
• AHRS A429 Heading • Contact a Garmin dealer for
Invalid fault. service.
Sec 3
MFD
• Power Supply fault. • Contact a Garmin dealer for
service.
Avoidance
• AC reference is lost. • Contact a Garmin dealer for
Hazard
Sec 4
service.
• Application SCI • Contact a Garmin dealer for
Additional
integrity fault. service.
Features
Sec 5
• Configuration • Contact a Garmin dealer for
integrity fault. service.
• Calibration integrity • Contact a Garmin dealer for
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
fault. service.
• Unit fault. • Contact a Garmin dealer for
service.
Symbols
Sec 7
• Communication is
Sec 8
halted.
GATE MODE • Automated testing
Appendix A
is on.
GDL69 • GDL 69 has failed. • Contact a Garmin dealer for
service.
Index
data unreliable.
GPS(1/2) FAIL • Communication with • Use an alternate navigation
GPS 1 or GPS 2 is source.
Sec 3
MFD
lost.
GPS(1/2) PPS • Timing data from • Contact a Garmin dealer for
FAIL GPS 1 or GPS 2 is service.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
lost.
GSR FAIL • GSR has failed. • Contact a Garmin dealer for
service.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
required.
GWX SERVICE • GWX requires • Contact a Garmin dealer for
service. service.
Symbols
Sec 7
• Heading data is
unreliable.
Index
Foreword
disabled or defaulted
to GPS1 TRK.
• GDU is in the
System
Sec 1
reversionary
track-based mode.
HTAWS • External HTAWS is • Contact a Garmin dealer for
Sec 2
PFD
not available. Internal service.
TERRAIN-HSVT
alerting is enabled.
Sec 3
MFD
• External HTAWS
configuration
mismatch.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
IAS NO COMP • No data from one • Contact a Garmin dealer for
or more airspeed service.
sensors.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
<LRU> CAL • Error in the • Calibration service required.
calibration of the Contact a Garmin dealer for
indicated LRU. service.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
<LRU> CONFIG • Error in the • Configuration is required. Contact
configuration of the a Garmin dealer for service.
indicated LRU.
Symbols
Sec 7
is automatically
Sec 8
dimmed to reduce
power usage.
Appendix A
voltage. Display
is automatically
dimmed to reduce
Sec 2
power usage.
PFD
halted.
NAV(1/2) • Communication with • Switch to alternate form of
Avoidance
Hazard
lost. available.
• No data from the
Additional
Features
indicated navigation
Sec 5
receiver.
NO RADAR • No data is being sent • Contact a Garmin dealer for
& Alerts
Annun.
sensors.
Sec 7
exceedance.
Sec 8
• ADAS+ engine
trend monitor is
Appendix A
reporting a previous
exceedance.
RADAR • Data does not match • Contact a Garmin dealer for
CONTROLS for a duration of 15 service.
Index
Foreword
inoperative. GFDS is
not registered.
ROL NO COMP • No data from one • Contact a Garmin dealer for
System
Sec 1
or more roll attitude service.
sensors.
RS-232 CONFIG • RS-232 configuration • Contact a Garmin dealer for
Sec 2
PFD
error. service.
RS-485 CONFIG • RS-485 configuration • Contact a Garmin dealer for
error. service.
Sec 3
MFD
SIMULATOR • Simulator mode is
active. Do not use for
navigation.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
STORMSCOPE • Stormscope has • Contact a Garmin dealer for
failed or connection service.
is lost.
Additional
Features
Sec 5
SVT DISABLED • Outside of terrain • Repeat steps to reactivate SVT
database coverage with the appropriate PFD soft keys.
area. • Install 9 arc-second database
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
• Terrain database (GDU 620 SW v6.21 or earlier) or
resolution is too low. 4.9 arc second database
(GDU 620 SW v7.00 or later).
Symbols
Sec 7
alerting enabled.
• External TAWS
configuration
mismatch.
Index
support Terrain
database.
TERRAIN DSP • Terrain or obstacle • Update database.
System
Sec 1
database error in
TAWS B or
TERRAIN-SVT only.
Sec 2
PFD
failed.
• TAS/TCAS has been
in standby for more
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
than 60 seconds.
• TAS/TCAS is
inoperative or
Additional
Features
Sec 5
connection is lost.
TRAFFIC • ADS-B traffic data • Contact a Garmin dealer for
CONFIG does not match service.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
configuration.
TRAFFIC FAIL • Traffic device has • Contact a Garmin dealer for
failed. service.
Symbols
Sec 7
• Traffic data is no
longer displayed.
TRAFFIC STDBY • Traffic is in Standby • Check traffic system controls on
Glossary
Sec 8
Foreword
Traffic is now based
on track.
WX ALERT • Possible severe • Check weather radar.
System
Sec 1
weather ahead.
WX RADAR • Communication with • Contact a Garmin dealer for
weather radar is lost. service.
Sec 2
PFD
WX RDR • Weather radar • Contact a Garmin dealer for
SERVICE requires service. service.
WXR INPUT • Weather radar is • Contact a Garmin dealer for
Sec 3
MFD
FAULT not receiving one or service.
more inputs.
XPDR (1/2) • GTX1 or GTX 2 • Contact a Garmin dealer for
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
requires service. service.
• GTX 1 or GTX 2
is inoperative or
Additional
Features
Sec 5
connection to GDU
is lost.
Table 6-1 Alert Messages
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
software version of LRUs and the date of databases. There are no menu pages.
In the LRU Status column, a green check means the unit is present and operat-
ing properly, while a red “X” indicates an absence or failure.
System
Sec 1
Sec 2
PFD
Sec 3
MFD
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
System LRUs
Figure 6-1 System Status Displays
7 SYMBOLS
Foreword
The following tables describe the symbols that are found on the MFD Map
displays.
7.1 Map Page Symbols
System
Sec 1
Symbol Description
Unknown Airport
Sec 2
PFD
Non-towered, Non-serviced Airport
Towered, Non-serviced Airport
Sec 3
MFD
Non-towered, Serviced Airport
Avoidance
Towered, Serviced Airport
Hazard
Sec 4
Soft Surface, Serviced Airport
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Soft Surface, Non-serviced Airport
Private Airport
& Alerts
Annun.
Heliport
Sec 6
Intersection
Symbols
VOR/DME
ILS/DME or DME-only
Appendix A
VORTAC
TACAN
VRP (Visual Reporting Point)
Index
Symbol Description
Helipad
System
Sec 1
Airport Beacon
Sec 2
PFD
Description
Symbol
(Highest to Lowest Priority)
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Other Traffic
Sec 8
Symbol Description
Basic Non-Directional Traffic
Foreword
Basic Directional Traffic
System
Sec 1
Basic Off-scale Selected Traffic
Sec 2
PFD
Proximate Directional Traffic
Sec 3
MFD
Non-Directional Alerted Traffic
Avoidance
Off-Scale Non-Directional Alerted Traffic
Hazard
Sec 4
Directional Alerted Traffic
Additional
Features
Off-Scale Directional Alerted Traffic
Sec 5
Non-Directional Surface Vehicle
& Alerts
Annun.
Directional Surface Vehicle
Sec 6
Table 7-4 ADS-B Traffic Symbols
Symbols
Sec 7
Symbol Description
Interstate Highway
System
Sec 1
State Highway
US Highway
Sec 2
PFD
Medium City
Hazard
Sec 4
Large City
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
Symbol Description
Terrain Proximity Enabled and Available Indicator
Terrain Proximity Enabled and Not Available Indicator
System
Sec 1
Point Obstacle Enabled and Available Indicator
(Software version 5.12 and later)
Sec 2
Point Obstacle Enabled and Not Available Indicator
PFD
(Software version 5.12 and later)
Wire Obstacles Enabled and Available Indicator
Sec 3
MFD
(Software version 5.12 and later)
Wire Obstacles Enabled and Not Available Indicator
(Software version 5.12 and later)
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
StormScope
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Traffic Enabled and Available Indicator
Symbol Description
Generic Airplane
System
Sec 1
Low-Wing Prop
High-Wing Prop
Sec 2
PFD
Kit Plane
Turboprop
Sec 3
MFD
Twin-Engine Prop
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Single-Engine Jet
Business Jet
Additional
Features
Sec 5
Simple Airplane
2-Blade Rotorcraft
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
3-Blade Rotorcraft
Symbols
Sec 7
4-Blade Rotorcraft
Foreword
Symbol Description
Arrow
System
Sec 1
Measuring Cursor
Sec 2
PFD
MFD Wind Vector (w/ valid GPS solution)
Sec 3
MFD
Parallel Track Waypoint
Avoidance
Restricted/Prohibited/Warning/Alert
Hazard
Sec 4
TFR (Temporary Flight Restrictions)
Additional
Features
Sec 5
MOA
Class B Airspace
& Alerts
Annun.
Class C Airspace
Sec 6
Class D Airspace
User Waypoint
Symbols
Sec 7
7-8
Cover
TOC
190-00601-02 Rev. J
TOC Cover
8 GLOSSARY
Foreword
ACT, ACTV active, activate
ADC Air Data Computer
ADF Automatic Direction Finder
ADI Attitude Direction Indicator
System
Sec 1
ADS-B Automatic Dependent Surveillance - Broadcast
AFF Automatic Flight Following
AFM Airplane Flight Manual
AFMS Airplane Flight Manual Supplement
Sec 2
PFD
AGL Above Ground Level
AHRS Attitude and Heading Reference System
AIM Airman’s Information Manual
Sec 3
MFD
AIRMET Airman’s Meteorological Information
ALT altitude
AP autopilot
Avoidance
APR approach
Hazard
Sec 4
APT airport, aerodrome
ARINC Aeronautical Radio Incorporated
ARSPC airspace
Additional
Features
Sec 5
ARTCC Air Route Traffic Control Center
AS airspeed
ASOS Automated Surface Observing System
ATC Air Traffic Control
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
ATCRBS ATC Radar Beacon System
ATIS Automatic Terminal Information Service
AUX auxiliary
Symbols
C center runway
ºC degrees Celsius
CDI Course Deviation Indicator
CHNL channel
Index
CLD cloud
CLR clear
CONFIG configuration
Crosstrack Error The distance the aircraft is off a desired course in either
direction, left or right
CRS course
CRSR cursor
System
Sec 1
deg degree
MFD
DEP departure
Desired Track (DTK) The desired course between the active “from” and
“to” waypoints
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
DEST destination
DFLT default
DIS distance
Additional
Features
a destination waypoint
DME Distance Measuring Equipment
DP Departure Procedure
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
DPRT departure
DSBL disabled
DTK Desired Track
Symbols
Sec 7
ENR en route
En Route Safe Altitude The recommended minimum altitude within ten miles
left or right of the desired course on an active flight
Appendix A
plan or direct-to
ENT enter
ERR error
ESA En route Safe Altitude
ETA Estimated Time of Arrival
Index
ºF degrees Fahrenheit
FAA Federal Aviation Administration
Foreword
FCC Federal Communication Commission
FCST forecast
FD flight director
FIS-B Flight Information Services-Broadcast
System
Sec 1
FISDL Flight Information Service Data Link
FLTA Forward Looking Terrain Avoidance
FPL flight plan
FREQ frequency
Sec 2
PFD
FRZ freezing
FSS Flight Service Station
ft foot/feet
Sec 3
MFD
G/S, GS glideslope
GDC Garmin Air Data Computer
Avoidance
GDL Garmin Satellite Data Link
Hazard
Sec 4
GDU Garmin Display Unit
GEO geographic
GLS Global Navigation Satellite Landing System
Additional
Features
Sec 5
GMA Garmin Audio Panel System
GMT Greenwich Mean Time
GMU Garmin Magnetometer Unit
GPS Global Positioning System
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
GPSS GPS Roll Steering
Ground Speed The velocity that the aircraft is travelling relative to a
ground position
Symbols
HDG heading
Heading The direction an aircraft is pointed, based upon
Appendix A
hPa hectopascal
HPL Horizontal Protection Level
HSDB High-Speed Data Bus
INFO information
in HG inches of mercury
INT intersection(s)
Sec 3
MFD
LAT latitude
LCD Liquid Crystal Display
LCL local
Additional
Features
Sec 5
LOC localizer
LOI loss of integrity (GPS)
LON longitude
Symbols
MAG Magnetic
MAG VAR Magnetic Variation
Appendix A
Foreword
Minimum Safe Altitude Uses Grid MORAs to determine a safe altitude within
ten miles of the aircraft present position
MKR marker beacon
MOA Military Operations Area
System
Sec 1
MOV movement
mpm meters per minute
MSA Minimum Safe Altitude
MSG message
Sec 2
PFD
MSL Mean Sea Level
MT meter
mV millivolt(s)
Sec 3
MFD
MVFR Marginal Visual Flight Rules
NAV navigation
Avoidance
NAVAID NAVigation AID
Hazard
Sec 4
NCR Negative Climb Rate
NDB Non-Directional Beacon
NEXRAD Next Generation Radar
Additional
Features
Sec 5
OAT Outside Air Temperature
OBS Omni Bearing Selector
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
PA Proximity Advisory
PC personal computer
PDA Premature Descent Alert
Symbols
QTY quantity
Appendix A
Index
RT right
RTC Reduced Required Terrain Clearance
Sec 3
MFD
SFC surface
Hazard
Sec 4
SLP/SKD slip/skid
SMBL symbol
SPD speed
SRVC, SVC service
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
STD standard
Sec 7
SW software
SYS system
Appendix A
T true
TA Traffic Advisory
TACAN Tactical Air Navigation System
TAF Terminal Aerodrome Forecast
Index
Foreword
TCAS Traffic Collision Avoidance System
TEMP temperature
TERM terminal
TFR Temporary Flight Restriction
System
Sec 1
T HDG True Heading
TIS Traffic Information System
TMA Terminal Maneuvering Area
Topo topographic
Sec 2
PFD
Track Direction of aircraft movement relative to a ground
position; also ‘Ground Track’
TRK track
Sec 3
MFD
TRSA Terminal Radar Service Area
UNAVAIL unavailable
Avoidance
USR user
Hazard
Sec 4
UTC Coordinated Universal Time
UTM/UPS Universal Transverse Mercator/ Universal Polar
Stereographic Grid
Additional
Features
Sec 5
V, Vspeed velocity (airspeed)
VAR variation
VFR Visual Flight Rules
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
VHF Very High Frequency
VLOC VOR/Localizer Receiver
VMC Visual Meteorological Conditions
Symbols
VS Vertical speed
VSI Vertical Speed Indicator
Appendix A
XPDR transponder
XTK cross-track
8-8
Cover
TOC
190-00601-02 Rev. J
TOC Cover
APPENDIX A
Foreword
A.1 SD Card Use and Databases
The G500/G600 System uses Secure Digital (SD) cards to load and store
System
Sec 1
various types of data. For basic flight operations, SD cards are required for
database storage as well as database updates.
SD cards are required for Terrain, Obstacle, FliteChart, SafeTaxi, ChartView,
Sec 2
PFD
and Aviation database storage as well as Aviation, Jeppesen aviation and
ChartView database updates. For database updates, the database update datacard
must be inserted in the top SD card slot while the appropriate database card is
Sec 3
located in the bottom SD card slot. ChartView is an optional feature that requires
MFD
enablement by a Garmin dealer.
The unit will generate an error in the event that a database SD card is inserted
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
into the top slot. Aviation databases can be loaded from an SD card in either slot.
If the aviation database on the SD card is more than two cycles expired, and the
pilot declines the system’s prompt to update the aviation database, the system
Additional
Features
will provide a second prompt that allows the pilot to suppress future prompts to
Sec 5
update to that particular aviation database on that SD card.
NOTE: Ensure the GDU 620 is powered off before inserting or removing
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
an SD card.
database.
Inserting an SD Card
1. Insert the SD card in the SD card slot (the front of the card should be flush with
Glossary
Sec 8
Aviation Airport, NAVAID, Internal 28 days (on fly.garmin.com Updates installed via
Waypoint, and GDU 620 Thursdays) SD card and copied
Airspace information memory or into internal memory
SD card
System
Sec 1
diagrams Thursdays)
Terrain Topographic map, SD card As required fly.garmin.com 9 arc-second version
SVT, Terrain/TAWS required for SVT
Obstacle Obstacle information SD card 56 days (on fly.garmin.com
Sec 3
MFD
information Memory or
Sec 4
SD card
Airport Airport facility and SD card 56 days fly.garmin.com Database may be
Directory FBO information available in different
Additional
Features
Sec 5
versions. Update
cycle and content
may vary.
FliteCharts FAA-published SD card 28 days (on fly.garmin.com Disables 180 days
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Disables 70 days
after expiration date.
Table A-1 Database List
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Foreword
are provided by Garmin and may be downloaded from the Garmin website
fly.garmin.com onto a Garmin provided Supplemental datacard. Contact Garmin
at fly.garmin.com for aviation database updates and update kits. The Aviation
System
Sec 1
database is stored on an SD card. This datacard is used to transfer the database
from the top SD card slot to the datacard located in the bottom SD card slot.
Removal of the datacard in the bottom SD card slot is not required.
Sec 2
PFD
The optional ChartView database is updated on a 14 day cycle. The
ChartView database is provided directly from Jeppesen. ChartView is an
optional feature that requires enablement by a Garmin dealer. Contact Jeppesen
Sec 3
MFD
(www.jeppesen.com) for ChartView subscription and update information.
Updating the Aviation Database
Avoidance
1. With the G500/G600 System OFF, insert the SD card containing the aviation
Hazard
Sec 4
database update into the either card slot of the GDU 620 to be updated (label
of SD card should face up).
Additional
2. Turn the G500/G600 System ON.
Features
Sec 5
3. Verify the correct update cycle is loaded during power-up. Press the ENT key to
continue or the CLR key to cancel loading.
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
7. Press the DBASE soft key to place the cursor in the “DATABASE” window.
8. Turn the small MFD knob to scroll through the list and check that all databases
Appendix A
Foreword
WARNING: The data contained in the terrain and obstacle databases
comes from government agencies. Garmin accurately processes and cross-
validates the data, but cannot guarantee the accuracy and completeness
of the data.
System
Sec 1
The following GDU 620 databases are stored on Supplemental datacards
provided by Garmin:
• Aviation – The aviation database contains airport, airspace, NAVAID, and
Sec 2
PFD
waypoint information. This database is updated on a 28 day cycle.
• Terrain – The terrain database contains terrain mapping data. This database
Sec 3
MFD
is updated periodically and has no expiration date.
• Obstacle – The obstacles database contains data for obstacles, such as
towers, that pose a potential hazard to aircraft. Obstacles 200 feet and
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
higher are included in the obstacle database. The rotorcraft database
includes all reported obstacles regardless of height. It is very important to
note that not all obstacles are necessarily charted and therefore may not
Additional
Features
be contained in the obstacle database. This database is updated on a 56-
Sec 5
day cycle. Obstacles will still be shown after the database has expired.
Several obstacle database options are available. Obstacle databases created
& Alerts
for GTN software version 5.10 or later include all power lines or only HOT
Annun.
Sec 6
lines depending on the type of obstacle database installed. Hazardous
Obstacle Transmission (HOT) Lines are power lines that are co-located
with other FAA-identified obstacles. The installed obstacle database type
Symbols
Sec 7
can be verified on the System Status page. Power line data is available for
the contiguous United States as well as small parts of Canada and Mexico.
• SafeTaxi – The SafeTaxi database contains detailed airport diagrams for
Glossary
Sec 8
will be displayed in white text on the startup screen if the database is not
installed. This database may be available in multiple versions with varying
update cycles and/or content.
System
Sec 1
Since these databases are not stored internally in the GDU 620, a Supplemental
Data Card containing identical database versions must be kept in each display
unit for dual installations. After subscribing to the desired database product,
the database product will need to be downloaded to a Supplemental Data Card.
Sec 2
PFD
Insert the Supplemental Data Card into the lower card slot shown in Figure
A-4. The Supplemental Data Card should not be removed except to update the
databases stored on the card. The upper slot is typically used for updating the
Sec 3
MFD
navigation database and is then normally left open. The Navigation card may be
inserted in either slot, but should use the same slot each time.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Database SD Card
databases onto the existing Supplemental Data Cards. The following equipment
is required to perform the update:
• Windows-compatible PC computer (Windows 2000, XP, Vista, or Windows
Glossary
Sec 8
7 recommended)
• SanDisk SD Card Reader, P/Ns SDDR-93 or SDDR-99 or equivalent card
Appendix A
reader
• Updated database obtained from the Garmin web site
• Existing Supplemental Database SD Card (P/N 010-00769-xx)
Index
Foreword
2. Insert the Database SD card in an empty card slot of the GDU 620. The SD card
containing the Aviation, ChartView, FliteCharts, SafeTaxi, or any other database
must be inserted into the lower slot on the GDU 620.
System
Sec 1
3. Apply power to the G500/G600 System. View the MFD power-up splash screen.
Check that the databases are initialized and displayed on the splash screen.
When updating the terrain and FliteCharts databases, an “in progress” message
may be seen. If this message is present, wait for the system to finish loading
Sec 2
PFD
before proceeding. Some databases can take up to 15 minutes to update.
4. Acknowledge the Power-up Page agreement by pressing the ENT key or the
right-most soft key. If a database is highlighted in yellow, it is either expired or
Sec 3
MFD
the G500/G600 can not determine the date.
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Additional
Features
Sec 5
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
5. Use the large MFD knob to select the AUX page group and then the small
MFD knob to reach the System Status Page.
6. Press the DBASE soft key to place the cursor in the “DATABASE” window.
Appendix A
7. Turn the small MFD knob to scroll through the list and check that all databases
are current and there are no errors.
8. Power down the GDU 620.
Index
A-8
Cover
TOC
190-00601-02 Rev. J
TOC Cover
Foreword
Altitude select 1-16
Symbols Altitude trend vector 2-13
1-2 key 2-3 Angle of incidence 4-94
Annunciations 1-12, 2-14, 2-15, 2-30,
A
System
4-10, 4-16, 4-17, 4-24, 4-29,
Sec 1
Above Ground Level 4-11 4-35, 4-36, 4-44, 4-46, 5-6, 6-1
ACT 4-110 Answering a phone call 3-66
Activating XM 5-22 Antenna 4-136
Sec 2
Active flight plan 2-15, 3-1, 3-67, 3-68, Antenna stabilization 4-108
PFD
3-69 Antenna tilt 4-91, 4-92, 4-96, 4-104,
Additional features 5-1 4-108, 4-112
ADF 1-1, 1-2, 2-2, 2-4, 2-28, 8-1 Approaches 2-24, 2-25, 4-20, 5-3, 5-4,
Sec 3
MFD
ADIZ 3-6, 3-11, 3-27 5-9, 5-13, 5-43, 8-1
ADS-B 4-47 Apt Dir 3-75
AFF 3-58 AP Test 2-3
Age 4-55 APTSIGNS 2-5
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
AHRS iii, 1-1, 1-5, 1-6, 1-12, 3-37, 6-2, Arc 4-6, 4-8, 4-13, 4-27
6-7, 6-9 Arrivals 5-3, 5-4
Aircraft symbol 2-9, 2-19, 3-3 Attitude 1-1, 1-5, 1-6, 1-12, 2-9, 2-11,
Additional
Air Data Computer 1-1, 1-5 5-31, 6-7, 8-1
Features
Sec 5
AIREP 4-128, 4-145 Attitude and Heading Reference System
AIRMETs 4-56, 4-70, 4-126, 4-142, 4-151 (AHRS) 1-5, 1-6, 1-12, 6-2
Airport beacon 7-2 Attitude Indicator 2-9–2-10
Aural message 4-11, 4-15, 4-16, 4-18,
& Alerts
Airport diagram 5-3, 5-4, A-5
Annun.
Sec 6
Airport Directory 3-75, A-6 4-22, 4-23, 4-24, 4-30
Airport signs 2-5, 5-42 Automatic flight following 3-58
Airspace labels 3-29 Autopilot 1-1, 2-3, 5-31
Symbols
Brightness 1-21, 1-22, 3-31, 3-32 Cursor 1-18, 3-7, 3-8, 3-9, 3-10, 3-21,
3-32, 3-34, 3-35, 3-36, 3-73,
C 3-75, 7-7
Sec 3
MFD
CDI source 2-22, 2-25, 2-28 5-3, 5-4, 5-21, 6-10, 6-14, A-1,
Cell movement 3-21, 3-22, 4-56, 4-82 A-5
Channel 1-10, 3-42, 5-25, 5-26, 5-27, Databases A-1
5-29 Database SYNC 3-44
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
ChartView database 5-3, 5-4, A-1, A-3 4-73, 4-75, 4-76, 4-78, 4-79,
Sec 7
City forecast 4-56, 4-77, 4-78 Date 1-21, 3-31, 3-38, 5-4, 5-21, 6-14,
Sec 8
Combined NEXRAD 4-142 Display units 1-22, 2-34, 3-31, 3-39, 3-40
Compass card 2-19, 2-21 Distance 1-21, 3-7, 3-9, 3-10, 3-12, 3-13,
Continental US NEXRAD 4-140 3-39, 3-67, 3-70
Foreword
Don’t sink 4-18, 4-23 GDU 620 1-1, 1-4
DP 5-3, 5-4 GDU 1040 1-1
Dual installation 2-16, 3-36, 3-70, 5-15, GFDS Weather 4-112
A-6 Glideslope 2-22, 2-24
System
Glossary 8-1
Sec 1
E GMU 44 1-1, 1-2, 1-8
Echo tops 4-56, 4-61, 4-65, 4-66, 4-67 GPS altitude ii, 4-4
ETA 3-67 GPS level of service 2-19, 2-21, 2-28
Excessive descent rate alert 4-18, 4-19
Sec 2
GPSS 5-34
PFD
Expiration time 4-52, 4-55, 4-151 Ground Clutter Suppression 4-110
Exposure level 4-95 Ground mapping 4-111, 4-112
External TAWS 4-25 Ground pointer 2-1, 2-10
Sec 3
MFD
Extreme attitude 2-11 Ground Radar 4-112
Extreme Pitch 2-11, 5-45 Ground return 4-94, 4-96, 4-112
Extreme Roll 2-12 Ground speed 2-5, 2-6, 2-11, 4-24, 5-41
GRS 77 1-1, 1-5, 1-14, 5-31
Avoidance
Hazard
F
Sec 4
GSR 56 1-9, 3-56, 3-59
Facility 3-70, 3-72, 3-73 GTP 59 1-2
Fast/Slow indication 2-34 GTX 33 1-11, 4-1
Additional
Field of view 3-11, 3-19 GTX 330/330D 1-11
Features
Sec 5
Five-hundred aural alert 4-18, 4-22 GWX 68 4-89
Flight director 5-34
Flight path marker 5-37, 5-41 H
Flight phase 4-20 Hail 4-61, 4-93, 4-98, 4-100
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Flight plan 1-21, 2-15, 2-24, 3-1, 3-2, Hazard avoidance 4-1
3-12, 3-67, 5-8 Haze 4-57
FliteCharts 5-3, 5-4, A-5, A-7 Heading 1-6, 1-16, 2-19, 2-20, 3-1, 3-37,
Symbols
GDC 74A ii, 1-1, 1-5, 1-8 Hot spots 5-18, 5-19
GDL 69/69A 1-2, 1-10, 3-21, 3-41, 3-42, Hrzn Hdg 2-5
4-1, 5-1, 5-22, 5-24, 5-25, 5-30 Hurricanes 4-136
4-144 4-138
Identifier 3-70, 3-71, 3-73, 5-8, 5-9, 5-42 Map panning 3-7
IFR 4-70, 4-127, 4-144 Map pointer 3-2, 3-7
IGRF model 1-5, 1-14 Map range 1-21, 3-2, 3-5, 3-12, 4-13,
5-18
System
Sec 1
Infra-Red 4-124
Inhibit alerting 4-28 Markings 2-7, 5-18, 5-19
Intersection 3-6, 3-25, 3-26, 5-19, 7-1 Measuring distance 3-9
Iridium 1-9, 3-56, 3-59, 4-1, 4-112 Menu Key 1-18, 1-19, 3-4, 3-10
Sec 3
MFD
4-151
L MFD 1-1, 1-4, 1-15, 1-18, 3-1
Land data 3-2, 3-11, 3-13, 3-15 MFD display units 3-31, 3-39
Additional
Lat/Lon 3-6, 3-11, 3-18, 3-70 Minimum Descent Altitude (MDA) 2-15
LDA 2-25 Minimums 5-15
Legend 3-11, 3-22, 4-5, 4-16, 4-53, 4-54, Miscellaneous symbols 7-7
Miscompare 2-31
& Alerts
Annun.
Mute 5-28
Sec 8
LPV 2-28
LRU 1-1, 1-3, 1-9, 3-43, 5-30, 6-14 4-79, 4-126, 4-142
Lubber line 2-19, 2-21 Nav angle 1-22, 2-20, 3-40
Navigation database 1-5, 1-14, A-3, A-6
M Navigation map 1-13, 1-18, 3-1, 3-2,
Index
Magnetometer 1-2, 1-6, 1-8 3-10, 4-5, 4-28, 4-52, 5-18, 5-19
Making a phone call 3-65 Navigation source iii, 2-3, 2-19, 2-22–2-
Map 3-2 24, 2-27, 2-28, 3-37, 3-67
Nav range ring 3-2, 3-11, 3-13 PFD display units 2-34
Nav Status Bar 2-1 PFD options 1-21, 3-31, 3-34, 3-35
Foreword
Nav status style 2-1, 3-31, 3-35 PFD soft keys 2-2
NDB 3-6, 3-11, 3-25, 3-26, 5-19, 7-1 Phone book 3-61
Negative climb rate 4-18, 4-23 Phone call 3-65
NEXRAD 3-21, 4-56, 4-59, 4-137, 4-138, Phone volume 3-64
System
4-151 Photocell 1-22
Sec 1
Legend 4-63, 4-139 Pilot Controlled Lighting 3-74
Limitations 4-61 PIREP 4-72, 4-128, 4-145
Viewing range 4-63, 4-138 Pitch indication 2-9, 2-11
Sec 2
NEXRAD Legend 3-22 Pitch scale 2-9, 5-40
PFD
Nexrad source 4-64 Position reporting 3-56
NEXRAD Viewing Range 3-22 Power 4-137
Night view 5-17 Power-up 1-5, 1-12, 1-14, 4-11, 4-24,
Sec 3
MFD
Normal display operation 1-1 4-44, 5-4, 5-21, A-3, A-7
North up 3-1, 3-11, 3-12, 4-52, 4-54, Precipitation 4-61, 4-65, 4-73, 4-90,
4-116 4-92, 4-93, 4-101, 4-108, 4-122,
NOTAM 5-3, 5-16 4-130, 4-147
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
Notes v Precipitation intensity levels 4-98, 4-105
NRST 5-8 Premature descent alerting 4-20
Preset 5-29
O
Additional
Product age 4-52, 4-55
Features
Sec 5
OAT 1-5, 1-8 Proximate advisory 7-2
OBS 1-16, 2-19, 2-23, 2-28, 3-37, 8-5 Proximity advisory 4-32
Obstacle data 3-17, 4-4, 4-24, A-5
Obstacles 3-13, 3-15, 3-17, 4-4, 4-9, R
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
4-10, 4-11, 4-43, 5-44, 7-4, A-5 Radar 4-41, 4-43, 4-59, 4-61, 4-65, 4-89,
Obstructions 4-9, 4-10 4-136, 4-137
Occluded front 4-78 Radar altimeter 2-13, 2-17, 2-32, 3-32
Symbols
RECENT 5-8
P Record of Revisions vi
Page group 1-18, 3-2 Reduced required obstacle clearance 4-20
Appendix A
Page menus 1-18, 1-19, 1-20, 3-10, 3-11, Reduced required terrain clearance 4-20
3-21, 3-24, 3-25, 3-32, 3-68, 4-6, Reference speed 2-8
4-14, 4-27, 4-53, 4-54 Reflectivity 4-60, 4-61, 4-93, 4-100,
Panning 3-7, 5-12, 5-19 4-137
Index
Soft keys 1-15, 1-19, 2-1, 2-2, 2-11, 3-1, Terrain 1-21, 2-11, 3-1, 3-13, 3-15,
4-31, 4-44, 5-26, 5-39, 5-41 4-1, 4-5, 4-10, 4-26, 4-43, 4-94,
Software version 3-43, 5-30, 6-14 4-111, 7-4, A-1
Speed 1-5, 1-21, 2-5, 2-8, 2-11, 2-18, Terrain alerts 4-23, 4-26, 4-29, 4-30, 5-37
Index
3-13, 3-31, 3-33, 3-39, 4-20, 4-40 Terrain data 3-11, 3-16, 4-8, 4-9, A-5
Speed range 2-7 Terrain obstacle symbols 4-12, 7-4
STAB 4-108
Terrain proximity ii, 1-21, 4-1, 4-5, 4-11, Version 1-12, 3-43, 4-11, 4-26, 5-21, A-6
7-6 Vertical deviation 2-24
Foreword
Terrain scale 4-6 Vertical scan 4-89, 4-98, 4-99, 4-103,
Terrain-SVT iv, 4-2, 4-26 4-105, 4-107
Textual METARs 4-74, 4-131, 4-148 Vertical speed 1-1, 1-5, 1-17, 1-21, 2-1,
TFR 3-11, 3-25, 3-27, 4-80, 4-134, 4-150, 2-11, 2-13, 2-18, 3-31, 3-37, 3-39
System
7-7 Vertical Speed Indicator (VSI) 1-21, 2-18
Sec 1
Thunderstorm 4-136 Video 3-51
Thunderstorms 4-57, 4-79, 4-93, 4-97, VNAV 2-24, 2-28
4-98, 4-100 VNV 8-7
Sec 2
Time 1-21, 3-13, 3-31, 3-38, 4-52, 4-56, Voice alert 4-43
PFD
4-77, 4-78, 4-151 Volume 1-10, 3-42, 5-25, 5-28
Time zone 3-38 VOR 1-16, 2-3, 2-20, 2-22, 2-27, 3-1,
TIS 4-31, 4-38, 4-40, 4-41, 4-43, 5-1 3-6, 3-11, 3-25, 3-26, 3-37, 4-12,
Sec 3
MFD
TMA 3-11, 3-26 5-19, 7-1
To/From Indicator 2-19, 2-20 VORTAC 7-1
Topo data 3-11, 3-15 Vspeeds 2-8, 3-33
Topo scale 3-11, 3-15
Avoidance
Hazard
W
Sec 4
Tornadoes 4-57, 4-79, 4-100
Tornados 4-136 WAAS 1-8, 2-24
Track indicator 2-19, 2-21 Warm front 4-77, 4-78
Additional
Track vector 3-2, 3-11, 3-13, 4-42 Warnings ii
Features
Sec 5
Traffic Advisory 3-24, 4-1, 4-31, 4-34, WATCH 4-92, 4-109
4-38, 7-2 Waypoint information 3-70, 3-72, 3-76,
Traffic Pop-Up 4-37 5-19
Traffic symbols 4-40, 4-49, 5-44, 7-2 Waypoint selection 3-71
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Transponder 1-11, 4-1, 4-31, 4-38, 4-41, Waypoint weather 3-76
4-43, 4-44 Weather 3-21, 3-76, 4-52, 4-112, 4-136
Trend Vector 2-6, 2-13, 2-19, 2-21 Weather legend 4-53, 4-58, 4-60
Symbols
True North 2-20, 3-40 Weather product 3-22, 4-52, 4-55, 4-58,
Turbulence 4-70, 4-88, 4-90, 4-93, 4-98, 4-63, 4-122, 4-138, 5-23
4-126, 4-142 Weather radar 1-2, 4-1, 4-89
Glossary
Turn Rate 2-19 Wind 1-21, 2-29, 3-2, 3-11, 3-13, 3-31,
Turn Rate Indicator 2-19, 2-21 3-34, 4-56, 4-57, 4-70, 4-73,
4-75, 4-127, 4-130, 4-132, 4-144,
Appendix A
X
XM 3-41, 3-42, 4-52, 5-22
XM channel categories 5-26
XM entertainment radio 5-22
System
Sec 1
XM weather/radio 1-10
XTK 2-22
Z
Avoidance
Hazard
Sec 4
& Alerts
Annun.
Sec 6
Symbols
Sec 7
Glossary
Sec 8
Appendix A
Index
Garmin Corporation
No. 68, Jangshu 2nd Road, Xizhi Dist., New Taipei City 221, Taiwan (R.O.C)
Tel. 886.2.2642.9199
Fax 886.2.2642.9099
www.garmin.com